blob: 93b9c65434897dd926a0987cd44ba3039b0231b0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200608 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200610 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - presetenv
614 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - uid
616 - ulimit-n
617 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200618 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100619 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100629 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100630 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100631 - 51degrees-data-file
632 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200633 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200634 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200635 - wurfl-data-file
636 - wurfl-information-list
637 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200638 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100639 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100642 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200643 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200645 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100646 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100647 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200649 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200650 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200651 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200652 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653 - noepoll
654 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000655 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100657 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300658 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000659 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100660 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200661 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200662 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200663 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000664 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000665 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200666 - tune.buffers.limit
667 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200669 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100670 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200671 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200672 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200673 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100674 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200675 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200676 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100677 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100678 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100679 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.session-timeout
681 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200682 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683 - tune.maxaccept
684 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200685 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200686 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200687 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100688 - tune.rcvbuf.client
689 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100690 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200691 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.sndbuf.client
693 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100694 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100695 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200696 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200698 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200699 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100700 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200701 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100702 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
704 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
705 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100706 - tune.zlib.memlevel
707 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709 * Debugging
710 - debug
711 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712
713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715------------------------------------
716
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200717ca-base <dir>
718 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200719 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
720 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722chroot <jail dir>
723 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
724 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
725 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
726 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
727 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
731 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
732 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
733 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
734 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
735 set. These sets have the format
736
737 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
738
739 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
742 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100743 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
744 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100746 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
750 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
751 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
752 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100753
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100754 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
755 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
756 on the machine's word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
760 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
761 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
762 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
763 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
764 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765
766 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
768
769 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
770 # first 4 CPUs
771
772 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
773 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
774 # word size.
775
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
781
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
783 # and so on.
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100788 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
790 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
791 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
792
793 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
794 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
796
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100797 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
798 # and a thread range.
799 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
802
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200803crt-base <dir>
804 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100805 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
806 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808daemon
809 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
810 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100811 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
812 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200813
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200814deviceatlas-json-file <path>
815 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100816 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200817
818deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100819 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
821
822deviceatlas-separator <char>
823 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
824 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
825
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100826deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200827 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
828 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
829 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100830
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900831external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
833 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100834 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
835 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
836 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
837 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
838 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840gid <number>
841 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
842 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
843 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100844 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
845 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100847
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100848group <group name>
849 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
850 See also "gid" and "user".
851
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100852hard-stop-after <time>
853 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
854
855 Arguments :
856 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
857 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
858 SIGUSR1 signal.
859
860 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
861 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
862 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
863
864 Example:
865 global
866 hard-stop-after 30s
867
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200868h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
869 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
870 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
871 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
872 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
873 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
874 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
875 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
876 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
877 specified in a proxy.
878
879 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
880 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
881 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
882 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
883 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
884 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
885 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
886
887 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
888 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
889 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
890 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
891 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
892
893 Example:
894 global
895 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
900h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
901 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
902 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
903 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
904 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
905 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
906 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
907 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
908 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
909
910 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
911 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
912 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
913
914 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
915 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
916
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100917insecure-fork-wanted
918 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
919 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
920 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
921 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
922 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
923 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
924 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
925 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
926 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
927 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
928 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
929 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
930 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
931 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
932 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
933 disable it.
934
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100935insecure-setuid-wanted
936 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
937 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
938 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
939 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
940 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
941 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
942 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
943 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
944 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
945 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
946 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
947 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
948 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
949 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
950
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200951log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
952 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100953 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100954 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 configured with "log global".
956
957 <address> can be one of:
958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100959 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100960 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
961 port).
962
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100963 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
964 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
965 port).
966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100968 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
969 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100970 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100971
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100972 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
973 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
974 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
975 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
976 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
977 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
978 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
979 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
980 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
981 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
982 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
983 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
984 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
985 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100986 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
987 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988
989 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
990 "fd@2", see above.
991
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200992 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
993 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
994 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
995 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
996 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
997
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
999 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001000
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001001 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1002 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1003 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1004 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1005 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1006 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1007 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1008 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1009 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1010 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001011 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1012 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001013
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001014 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1015 one of the following :
1016
1017 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1018 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1019
1020 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1021 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1022
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001023 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1024 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1025 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1026 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1027 logger consumes.
1028
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001029 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1030 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1031 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1032 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1033
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001034 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1035 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1036 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1037 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1038 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1039
1040 <sample_size>
1041 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1042 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1043 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1044 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1045 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1046
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001047 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001049 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1050 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1051 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1052
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001053 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1054 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1055 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1056 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
1058 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001059 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1060 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1061 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1062 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1063 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1064 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001066 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001068log-send-hostname [<string>]
1069 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1070 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1071 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1072 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1073 the logs.
1074
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075log-tag <string>
1076 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1077 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1078 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001079 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001080
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001081lua-load <file>
1082 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1083 used multiple times.
1084
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001085master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001086 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1087 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1088 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001089 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001090 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1091 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001092 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1093 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1094 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1095 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1096 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001097
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001098 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001099
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001100mworker-max-reloads <number>
1101 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001102 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001103 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1104 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1105 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107nbproc <number>
1108 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1109 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1110 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001111 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1112 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001113 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1114 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001116nbthread <number>
1117 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001118 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1119 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1120 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1121 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1122 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001123 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1124 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1125 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1126 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1127 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1128 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1129 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1134 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1135
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001136presetenv <name> <value>
1137 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1138 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1139 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1140 and "unsetenv".
1141
1142resetenv [<name> ...]
1143 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1144 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1145 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1146 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1147 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1148 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1149 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1150 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1151
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001152stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001153 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1154 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1155 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1156 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1157 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1158 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001159 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001160 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1161 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1162 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1163 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001164
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165server-state-base <directory>
1166 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001167 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1168 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001169
1170server-state-file <file>
1171 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1172 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1173 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1174 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1175 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1176 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1177 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1178 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001179 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1180 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001182setenv <name> <value>
1183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1186 and "unsetenv".
1187
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001188set-dumpable
1189 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001190 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1191 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1192 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1193 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1194 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1195 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1196 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1197 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1198 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1199 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1200 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1201 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1202 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1203 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1204 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1205 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1206 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001207
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001208ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1210 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001211 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001212 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001213 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1214 information and recommendations see e.g.
1215 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1216 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1217 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1218 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001219
1220ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1222 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1223 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1224 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1225 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001226 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1227 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1228 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001229 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001230
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001231ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1233 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1234 keyword to see available options.
1235
1236 Example:
1237 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001238 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001239
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001240ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1242 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001243 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001244 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001245 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1246 information and recommendations see e.g.
1247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1249 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1250 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1251 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001252
1253ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1256 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1257 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1258 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001259 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1260 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1261 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1262 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001263
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001264ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1267 keyword to see available options.
1268
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1271 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1272 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1276 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1277 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1278 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001279 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1280 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1281 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1282
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001283ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1284 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1285 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1286 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1287
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001288stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1289 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1290 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1291 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001292 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001293 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001294
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001295 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1296 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1297 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1300 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1301 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001302 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001303
1304stats maxconn <connections>
1305 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1306 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308uid <number>
1309 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1310 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1311 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1312 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1313
1314ulimit-n <number>
1315 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1316 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1317 option.
1318
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001319unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1320 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1321
1322 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1323 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1324 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1325 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1326 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1327 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1328 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1329 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1330 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1331 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1332
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001333unsetenv [<name> ...]
1334 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1335 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1336 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1337 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1338 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1339 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1340 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342user <user name>
1343 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1344 See also "uid" and "group".
1345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001346node <name>
1347 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1348
1349 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1350 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1351 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1352 traffic.
1353
1354description <text>
1355 Add a text that describes the instance.
1356
1357 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1358 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1359 "<" and ">" characters.
1360
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136151degrees-data-file <file path>
1362 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001366 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1370 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1371 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1372
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001374 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1375
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001377 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1378 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1379
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1381 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1382
138351degrees-cache-size <number>
1384 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1385 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1386 By default, this cache is disabled.
1387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001389 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1390
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001391wurfl-data-file <file path>
1392 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1393 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1394
1395 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1396 with USE_WURFL=1.
1397
1398wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1399 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1400 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1401 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1402
1403 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1404
1405 Valid WURFL properties are:
1406 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1407
1408 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1409 device.
1410
1411 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1412 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1413
1414 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1415 particular web request.
1416
1417 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1418 used Libwurfl API version.
1419
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001420 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1421 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1422
1423 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1424 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1425
1426 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1427
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001428 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1429 with USE_WURFL=1.
1430
1431wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1432 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1433 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1434
1435 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1436 with USE_WURFL=1.
1437
1438wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1439 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1440 thus before the chroot.
1441
1442 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1443 with USE_WURFL=1.
1444
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001445wurfl-cache-size <size>
1446 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1447 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001448 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001449 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001450
1451 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1452 with USE_WURFL=1.
1453
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001454strict-limits
1455 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1456 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1457 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1458 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1459 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1460 keyword.
1461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014623.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463-----------------------
1464
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001465busy-polling
1466 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1467 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1468 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1469 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1470 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1471 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1472 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1473 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1474 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1475 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1476 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1477 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1478 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1479 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1480 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1481 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1482 "poll" pollers.
1483
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001484 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1485 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1486 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1487
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001488max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1489 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1490 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1491 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1492 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1493 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1494 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1495 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1496 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498maxconn <number>
1499 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1500 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1501 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001502 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1503 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1504 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1505 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001506 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1507 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1508 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1509 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1510 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1511 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001513maxconnrate <number>
1514 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1515 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1516 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1517 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1518 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1519 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1520 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1521 fairness.
1522
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001523maxcomprate <number>
1524 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001526 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1527 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1528 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001529 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001530 default value.
1531
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001532maxcompcpuusage <number>
1533 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1534 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1535 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1536 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1537 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1538 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1539 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1540 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1541
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001542maxpipes <number>
1543 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1544 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1545 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1546 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1547 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1548 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1549
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001550maxsessrate <number>
1551 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1552 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1553 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1554 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1555 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1556 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1557 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1558 fairness.
1559
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001560maxsslconn <number>
1561 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1562 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1563 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1564 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1565 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1566 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1567 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001568 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1569 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1570 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1571 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1572 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1573 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1574 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001575
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001576maxsslrate <number>
1577 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1578 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1579 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1580 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1581 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1582 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1583 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1584 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1585 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1586 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1587
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001588maxzlibmem <number>
1589 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1590 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1591 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001592 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1593 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1594 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596noepoll
1597 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1598 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001599 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001600
1601nokqueue
1602 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1603 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1604 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1605
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001606noevports
1607 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1608 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1609 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1610 also "nopoll".
1611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001612nopoll
1613 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1614 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001616 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1617 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001619nosplice
1620 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001622 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001624 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1625 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1626 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1627 "option splice-response".
1628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001629nogetaddrinfo
1630 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1631 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1632
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001633noreuseport
1634 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1635 command line argument "-dR".
1636
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001637profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1638 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1639 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1640 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1641 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001642 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001643 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1644 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1645 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1646 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1647
1648 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1649 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1650 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1651 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1652 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001653 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1654 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1655 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1656 CLI.
1657
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001658spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001659 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1660 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1661 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1662 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1663 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1664 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001666ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001669 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1670 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1671 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1672 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1673 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001674 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1675 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001676 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1677 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1678 openssl configuration file uses:
1679 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1680
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001681ssl-mode-async
1682 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001683 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001684 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1685 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1686 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001687 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001688 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001689
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001690tune.buffers.limit <number>
1691 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1692 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1693 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1694 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1695 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001696 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001697 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1698 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1699 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1700 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1701 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1702 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1703 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1704 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1705 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1706
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001707tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1708 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1709 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1710 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1711 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001713tune.bufsize <number>
1714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1722 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1723 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001724 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001725 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1726 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1727 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001729tune.chksize <number>
1730 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1731 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1732 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1733 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1734 checks whenever possible.
1735
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001736tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1737 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1738 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1739 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1740 this value. The default value is 1.
1741
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001742tune.fail-alloc
1743 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1744 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1745 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1746 gracefully.
1747
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001748tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1749 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1750 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1751 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1752 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1753 change it.
1754
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001755tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1756 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1758 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001759 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1760 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1761 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1762 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1763 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1764
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001765tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1767 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1768 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1769 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1770 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1771 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1772 recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001774tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1775 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1776 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1777 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1778 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1779 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1780 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1781 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1782
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001783tune.http.cookielen <number>
1784 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1785 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1786 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1787 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1788 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1789 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1790 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1791 to change this value.
1792
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001793tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1795 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001796 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001798 configuration directives too.
1799 The default value is 1024.
1800
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001801tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1802 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1803 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1804 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1805 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1806 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1807 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001808 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1809 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1810 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001811
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812tune.idletimer <timeout>
1813 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1814 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1815 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1816 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1817 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1818 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001821 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1822
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001823tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1825 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1826 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1827 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1828 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1829 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1830 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1831 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1832 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1833
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001834tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1835 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001836 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001837 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1838 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1841 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1842
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001843tune.lua.maxmem
1844 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1845 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1846 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1847 memory.
1848
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001849tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1850 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001851 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1852 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001854
1855tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1856 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1857 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1858 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1859 check servers.
1860
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001861tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1862 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1863 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1864 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001866
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001867tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001868 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1869 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1870 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1871 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1872 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1873 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1874 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1875 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1876 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1877 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001878
1879tune.maxpollevents <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1881 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1882 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1883 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1884 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.maxrewrite <number>
1887 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1888 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1889 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1890 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1891 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1892 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1893 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1894 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1895 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1896 bufsize.
1897
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001898tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1899 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1900 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1901 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1902 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1903 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1904 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1905 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1906 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1907 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001908 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1909 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001910 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1911 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1912 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1913 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1914 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1915 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1916 setting this parameter to 0.
1917
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001918tune.pipesize <number>
1919 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1920 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1921 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1922 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1923 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1924 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1925
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001926tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1927 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1928 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1929 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1930 default is 20.
1931
1932tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1933 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1934 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1935 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1936 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1937 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1938 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001940
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001941tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1942tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1943 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1944 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1945 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001946 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001948 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1949 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1950
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001951tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001952 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001953 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1954 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1955 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1956 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1957
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001958tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001960 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1961 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1962
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001963tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1964tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1965 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1966 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1967 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001968 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001970 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1971 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1972 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1973 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1974 notifying haproxy again.
1975
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001976tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001977 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1978 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1979 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001980 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001981 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001982 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001983 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1984 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1985 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001986 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1987 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001988
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001989tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001990 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001991 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1992 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1993 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1994 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1995 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1996
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001997tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1998 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001999 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002000 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2001 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2002 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2003 being used for too long.
2004
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002005tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2006 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2007 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2008 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2009 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2010 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2011 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2012 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2013 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2014 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2015 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002016 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002018
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002019tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2020 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2021 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2022 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2023 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2024 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2025 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2026 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002027 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2028 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002029
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002030tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2031 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2032 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2033 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2034 1000 entries.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002036tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2037 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2038 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2039 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002041tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002042tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002043tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2045tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002046 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2047 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2048 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2049 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2050 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2051 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2052 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2053 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002055 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2056 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2057 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2058 all available space is consumed.
2059 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2060 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2061 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002062
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002063tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2064 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002066 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002068 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2069
2070tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2071 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2072 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2074 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020763.3. Debugging
2077--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002078
2079debug
2080 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2081 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2082 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2083 system startup.
2084
2085quiet
2086 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2087 line argument "-q".
2088
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020903.4. Userlists
2091--------------
2092It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2093http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2094it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2095
2096userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002097 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2099
2100group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002101 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002102 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2103 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2104
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002105user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2106 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002107 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2108 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002109 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2110 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2111 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2112 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002113
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002114 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2115 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2116 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2117 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2118 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2119 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2120 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2121 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2122 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
2124 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002125 userlist L1
2126 group G1 users tiger,scott
2127 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002128
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002129 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2130 user scott insecure-password elgato
2131 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002132
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002133 userlist L2
2134 group G1
2135 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2138 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2139 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002140
2141 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002143
21443.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002145----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002146It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2147several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2148instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2149values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2150automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2151In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2152using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2153tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2154reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2155Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2156that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2157each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002158
2159peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002160 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002161 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2165 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2166
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002167disabled
2168 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2169 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2170 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2171
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002172default-bind [param*]
2173 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2174
2175default-server [param*]
2176 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2177
2178 Arguments:
2179 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2180 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2181 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2182 details.
2183
2184
2185 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2186
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002187enable
2188 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2189
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002190log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2191 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2192 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2193 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2194 more details.
2195
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002196peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002197 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2198 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2199 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2200 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2201 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2202 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2203
2204 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2205 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2206
2207 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2208 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2209 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2210 across all peers.
2211
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002212 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2213 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002214
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002215 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2216 "server" keyword explanation below).
2217
2218server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002219 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002220 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2221 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2222 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2223 of this "peers" section).
2224 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2225
2226
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002227 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002228 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002229 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002230 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2231 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2232 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
2234 backend mybackend
2235 mode tcp
2236 balance roundrobin
2237 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2238 stick on src
2239
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002240 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2241 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002242
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002243 Example:
2244 peers mypeers
2245 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2246 default-server ssl verify none
2247 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2248 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002249
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002250
2251table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2252 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2253
2254 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2255 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002256 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002257 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2258 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2259 "stick-table" keyword).
2260
2261 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2262 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2263 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2264 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2265 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2266 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2267 of the stick-table name as follows:
2268
2269 peers mypeers
2270 peer A ...
2271 peer B ...
2272 table t1 ...
2273
2274 frontend fe1
2275 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2276
2277 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2278 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2279
2280 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2281 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2282 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2283 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2284 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2285 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2286 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2287
2288 peers mypeers
2289 peer A ...
2290 peer B ...
2291 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2292
2293 backend t1
2294 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2295
2296 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2297 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2298 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2299
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023003.6. Mailers
2301------------
2302It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2303If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2304in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2305
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002306mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002307 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2308 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2309
2310mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2311 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2312
2313 Example:
2314 mailers mymailers
2315 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2316 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2317
2318 backend mybackend
2319 mode tcp
2320 balance roundrobin
2321
2322 email-alert mailers mymailers
2323 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2324 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2325
2326 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2327 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2328
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002329timeout mail <time>
2330 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2331 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2332 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2333 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2334
2335 Example:
2336 mailers mymailers
2337 timeout mail 20s
2338 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002339
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023403.7. Programs
2341-------------
2342In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2343master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2344managed the same way as the workers.
2345
2346During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2347sequence as a worker:
2348
2349 - the master is re-executed
2350 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2351 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2352 instance of the program
2353
2354During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2355
2356program <name>
2357 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2358 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2359 the management guide).
2360
2361command <command> [arguments*]
2362 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2363 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2364 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2365 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2366
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002367user <user name>
2368 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2369 See also "group".
2370
2371group <group name>
2372 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2373 See also "user".
2374
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002375option start-on-reload
2376no option start-on-reload
2377 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2378 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2379 program section.
2380
2381
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010023823.8. HTTP-errors
2383----------------
2384
2385It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2386imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2387several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2388
2389http-errors <name>
2390 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2391 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2392
2393errorfile <code> <file>
2394 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2395
2396 Arguments :
2397 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2398 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2399 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2400
2401 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2402 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2403 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2404 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2405 before any chroot is performed.
2406
2407 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2408
2409 Example:
2410 http-errors website-1
2411 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2412 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2413 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2414
2415 http-errors website-2
2416 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2417 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2418 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2419
2420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002422----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002424Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002425 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002426 - frontend <name>
2427 - backend <name>
2428 - listen <name>
2429
2430A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2431its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2432section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002434
2435A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2436connections.
2437
2438A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2439to forward incoming connections.
2440
2441A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2442parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2445'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2446case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2447
2448Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2449logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2450proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2451However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2452name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2453
2454Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2455and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002456bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2458modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2459arbitrary criteria.
2460
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002461In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2462a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002463the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002464
2465 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2466 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2467 between responses and new requests.
2468
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002469 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2470 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2471 client-facing connection remains open.
2472
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002473 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2474 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002475
2476The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2477frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2478following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002479weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002480
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002481 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002483 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2484 ----+-----+-----+----
2485 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2486 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002487 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2488 ----+-----+-----+----
2489 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024934.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2494--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002496The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2497limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2498they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2499limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002502and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2503with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2504specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002506
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2508------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2509acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510backlog X X X -
2511balance X - X X
2512bind - X X -
2513bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514capture cookie - X X -
2515capture request header - X X -
2516capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002517compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002518cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002519declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520default-server X - X X
2521default_backend X X X -
2522description - X X X
2523disabled X X X X
2524dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002525email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002526email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002527email-alert mailers X X X X
2528email-alert myhostname X X X X
2529email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530enabled X X X X
2531errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002532errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533errorloc X X X X
2534errorloc302 X X X X
2535-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2536errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002537force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002538filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539fullconn X - X X
2540grace X X X X
2541hash-type X - X X
2542http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002544http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002545http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002546http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002547http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002548http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002550ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002551load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002552log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002553log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002554log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002555log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002556max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557maxconn X X X -
2558mode X X X X
2559monitor fail - X X -
2560monitor-net X X X -
2561monitor-uri X X X -
2562option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2563option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2564option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2565option allbackups (*) X - X X
2566option checkcache (*) X - X X
2567option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2568option contstats (*) X X X -
2569option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2570option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2572option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002573option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2574option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002575option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002576option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002577option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002578option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002579option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2581option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2582option httpchk X - X X
2583option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002584option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002587option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002588option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002589option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2590option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2591option logasap (*) X X X -
2592option mysql-check X - X X
2593option nolinger (*) X X X X
2594option originalto X X X X
2595option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002596option pgsql-check X - X X
2597option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002599option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600option smtpchk X - X X
2601option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2602option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2603option splice-request (*) X X X X
2604option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002605option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2607option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2608-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002609option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2611option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2612option tcpka X X X X
2613option tcplog X X X X
2614option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002615external-check command X - X X
2616external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2618rate-limit sessions X X X -
2619redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002621retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002622retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002624server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002625server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002627stats admin - X X X
2628stats auth X X X X
2629stats enable X X X X
2630stats hide-version X X X X
2631stats http-request - X X X
2632stats realm X X X X
2633stats refresh X X X X
2634stats scope X X X X
2635stats show-desc X X X X
2636stats show-legends X X X X
2637stats show-node X X X X
2638stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2640stick match - - X X
2641stick on - - X X
2642stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002643stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002644stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002645tcp-check connect - - X X
2646tcp-check expect - - X X
2647tcp-check send - - X X
2648tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002649tcp-request connection - X X -
2650tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002651tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002652tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002653tcp-response content - - X X
2654tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655timeout check X - X X
2656timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002657timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2660timeout http-request X X X X
2661timeout queue X - X X
2662timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002663timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002664timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002665timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002667unique-id-format X X X -
2668unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002669use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002670use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002671use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002672------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2673 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2677---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678
2679This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2680
2681
2682acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2683 Declare or complete an access list.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 no | yes | yes | yes
2686 Example:
2687 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2688 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2689 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
2693
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002694backlog <conns>
2695 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2697 yes | yes | yes | no
2698 Arguments :
2699 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2700 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002701 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002702
2703 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2704 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2705 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2706 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2707 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2708 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2709 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2710 backlog parameter.
2711
2712 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2713 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2714 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2715
2716 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2717
2718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002720balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | no | yes | yes
2724 Arguments :
2725 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2726 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2727 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2728 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2729
2730 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2731 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2732 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2733 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002734 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002735 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002736 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2737 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2738 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2739 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2740 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2741 it, so that you don't worry.
2742
2743 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2744 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2745 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2746 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2747 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2748 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2749 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2750 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002752 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2753 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2754 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2755 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2756 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2757 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2758 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2759 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2760
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002761 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002762 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002763 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2764 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002765 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002766 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2767 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2768 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2769 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2770 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002771 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2772 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2773 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2774 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2775 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2776 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2779 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2780 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2781 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2782 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2783 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2784 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2785 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002786 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002788 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2789 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2790 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002792 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2793 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2794 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2795 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2796 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2797 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2798 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2799 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2800 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2801 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2802 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2803 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002805 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002806 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2807 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2808 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2809 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2810 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2811 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2812 URIs start with a leading "/".
2813
2814 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2815 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2816 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2817 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2821
2822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002832
2833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2836 server will receive the request.
2837
2838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2861
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002862 random
2863 random(<draws>)
2864 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002865 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2866 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2867 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2868 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002869 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2870 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2871 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2872 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2873 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2874 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2875 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2876 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2877 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2878 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2879 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2880 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2881 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2882 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2883 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2884 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2885 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2886 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2887 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2888 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002889
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002890 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002891 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002892 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2893 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2894 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2895 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2896 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2897 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002898 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002899 used instead.
2900
2901 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2902 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2903 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2904 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2909
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002910 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002913 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2914 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002915
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002916 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2917 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2918 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002920 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002921 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002922 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2923 NTLM relies on.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Examples :
2926 balance roundrobin
2927 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002928 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002929 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2930 balance hdr(host)
2931 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002932
2933 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2934 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002936 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002937 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2938 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2939 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002940 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941
2942 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2943 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2944 defaults to 16 kB.
2945
2946 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2947 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2948
2949 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2950 Round Robin.
2951
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002952 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2954 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2955 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2956
2957 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2958
2959 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002960 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002961 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2962 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2963 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002965 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002968bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2969bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2972 no | yes | yes | no
2973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002974 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2975 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2976 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2977 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002978 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002979 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2980 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2981 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2982 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2983 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2984 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2985 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002986 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2987 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2988 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2989 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2990 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2991 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2992 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002993 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2994 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2995 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002996 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2997 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2998 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2999 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003000 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3001 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3002 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003003
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003004 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3005 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003006 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3007 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3008 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003009 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3010 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3011 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3012 the range.
3013
3014 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3015 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3016 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3017 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3018 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3019 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3020 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003021 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003022 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003024 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003025 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003026 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3027 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3028 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3029 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3030 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3031 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003033 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3034 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3035 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3036 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3039 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3040 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3041 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3042 in a frontend.
3043
3044 Example :
3045 listen http_proxy
3046 bind :80,:443
3047 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003048 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003050 listen http_https_proxy
3051 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003052 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003053
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003054 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3055 bind ipv6@:80
3056 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3057 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3058
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003059 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003060 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003061
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003062 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3063 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3064 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3065 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3066 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003068 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003069 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003072bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3078 may be used to override a default value.
3079
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003080 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081 option may be combined with other numbers.
3082
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003083 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003084 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3085 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3086 missing from all processes.
3087
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003088 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003089 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003090 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3091 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3092 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3093 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3094 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003095 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003096
3097 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3098 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3099 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3100 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3101 and 'even' instances.
3102
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003103 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3104 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3105 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3106 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003107
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003108 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3109 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3110
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003111 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3112 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3113 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3114
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003115 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3116 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3117
3118 Example :
3119 listen app_ip1
3120 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003121 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003122
3123 listen app_ip2
3124 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003125 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003126
3127 listen management
3128 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003129 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003130
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003131 listen management
3132 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3133 bind-process 1-4
3134
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003135 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003136
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138capture cookie <name> len <length>
3139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 no | yes | yes | no
3142 Arguments :
3143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3152 right if it exceeds <length>.
3153
3154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3158
3159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3162
3163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
3170 Example:
3171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3172
3173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
3176
3177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 no | yes | yes | no
3181 Arguments :
3182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3187
3188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3190 it exceeds <length>.
3191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 environments to find where the request came from.
3201
3202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
3213 Example:
3214 capture request header Host len 15
3215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 about logging.
3220
3221
3222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 no | yes | yes | no
3226 Arguments :
3227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3232
3233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3235 it exceeds <length>.
3236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251
3252 Example:
3253 capture response header Content-length len 9
3254 capture response header Location len 15
3255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003257 about logging.
3258
3259
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003260compression algo <algorithm> ...
3261compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003262compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003263 Enable HTTP compression.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003267 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3268 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3269 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3270
3271 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003272 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3273 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3274 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003276 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003277 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003278
3279 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3280 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3281 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3282 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3283 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003284 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003285
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003286 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3287 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3288 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3289 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3290 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3291 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3292 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003293 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003294
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003295 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003296 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003297 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3298 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3299 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3300 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3301 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003302
3303 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3304 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3305 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3306 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3307 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003308 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3309 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3310 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3311 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3312 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003313 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3314 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003315
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003316 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003317 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3318 "Accept-Encoding" header
3319 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003320 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003321 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3322 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3323 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3324 "multipart"
3325 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3326 header
3327 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3328 and later
3329 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3330 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003331 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003332
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003333 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003334
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003335 Examples :
3336 compression algo gzip
3337 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003340cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003341 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3342 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003343 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | no | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3349 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3350 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3351 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3352 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3353 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003354 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3356 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3357
3358 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3359 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3360 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3361 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3362 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3363 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003364 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3365 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003366 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003367 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3368 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003369
3370 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003371 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003372
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003373 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003374 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003375 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003377 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3378 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3379 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3380 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3381 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3382 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3383 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
3385 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3386 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3387 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3388 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3389 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3390 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3391 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3392 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3393 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003394 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003395 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3396 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3397 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003399 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3400 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3401 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003402 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3403 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3404 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3405 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3407 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3408 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
3410 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3411 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3412 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3413 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3414 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3415 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3416 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3417 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3418 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3419
3420 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3421 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3422 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3423 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3424 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3425 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3426 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3427 persistence cookie in the cache.
3428 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3429
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003430 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3431 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3432 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3433 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3434 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003435 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003436 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3437 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3438 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3439 they logout.
3440
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003441 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3442 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3443 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3444 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3445
3446 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3447 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3448 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3449 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3450 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3451 this attribute.
3452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003453 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003455 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3456 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3457 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3458 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3459 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3460 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3463 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3464 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3465 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3466 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3467 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3468 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3469 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003471 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3472 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3473 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3474 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3475 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3476 the site.
3477
3478 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3479 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3480 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3481 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3482 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3483 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3484 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3485 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3486 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3487 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3488 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3489 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3490 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003491 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003492 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3493 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3494
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003495 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3496 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3497 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3498 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3499 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3500 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3503 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3504 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3505 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 Examples :
3508 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3509 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3510 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003511 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003513 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003515
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003516declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3517 Declares a capture slot.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 no | yes | yes | no
3520 Arguments:
3521 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3522
3523 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3524 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3525 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3526 for use in the response.
3527
3528 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003529 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003530 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3531
3532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003533default-server [param*]
3534 Change default options for a server in a backend
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003538 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3539 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3540 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3541 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003542
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003543 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003544 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3545
3546 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003547
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549default_backend <backend>
3550 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | yes | yes | no
3553 Arguments :
3554 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3555
3556 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3557 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3558 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3559 will catch all undetermined requests.
3560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561 Example :
3562
3563 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3564 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3565 default_backend dynamic
3566
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003567 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003570description <string>
3571 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 no | yes | yes | yes
3574 Arguments : string
3575
3576 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3577 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3578 it describes.
3579 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3580
3581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582disabled
3583 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | yes
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3589 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3590 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3591 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3592 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3593 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3594 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3595
3596 See also : "enabled"
3597
3598
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003599dispatch <address>:<port>
3600 Set a default server address
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003604
3605 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3606 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3607 during start-up.
3608
3609 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3610 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3611 possible with normal servers.
3612
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003613 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3615 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3616 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3617 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3618
3619 See also : "server"
3620
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003621
3622dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3623 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | no | yes | yes
3626 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3627
3628 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003630 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3631 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003633 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635enabled
3636 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | yes
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3642 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3643
3644 See also : "disabled"
3645
3646
3647errorfile <code> <file>
3648 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | yes
3651 Arguments :
3652 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003653 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3654 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
3656 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003657 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003659 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3660 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661
3662 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3663 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3664 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3665
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003666 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3669 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3670 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3671 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3672
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003673 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3674 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003675 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003676 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3677 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3678 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3681 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3682 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003683 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3685
3686 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 Example :
3689 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003690 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3692 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003695errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3696 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3697 section.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments :
3701 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3702
3703 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3704 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3705 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3706
3707 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3708 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3709 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3710 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3711 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3712 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3713 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3714
3715 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3716 3.8 about http-errors.
3717
3718 Example :
3719 errorfiles generic
3720 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3721
3722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003723errorloc <code> <url>
3724errorloc302 <code> <url>
3725 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728 Arguments :
3729 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003730 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3731 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732
3733 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3734 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3735 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3736 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003737 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738
3739 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3740 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3741 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3742
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003743 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003745 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3746 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3747 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3748 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003749 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3751 request.
3752
3753 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3754
3755
3756errorloc303 <code> <url>
3757 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760 Arguments :
3761 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003762 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3763 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764
3765 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3766 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3767 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3768 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003769 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3772 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3773 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3774
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003775 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003777 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3778 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3779 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3780 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003781 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782
3783 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3784
3785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003786email-alert from <emailaddr>
3787 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003788 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | yes
3791
3792 Arguments :
3793
3794 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3795
3796 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3797 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3798
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003799 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003800 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3801 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003802
3803
3804email-alert level <level>
3805 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3806 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | yes | yes | yes
3809
3810 Arguments :
3811
3812 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3813 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3814 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3815
3816 By default level is alert
3817
3818 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3819 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3820 for the proxy.
3821
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003822 Alerts are sent when :
3823
3824 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3825 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3826 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3827 is notice or lower
3828 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3829 and a health check status update occurs
3830
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003831 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3832 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003833 section 3.6 about mailers.
3834
3835
3836email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3837 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840
3841 Arguments :
3842
3843 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3844
3845 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3846 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3847
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003848 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3849 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003850
3851
3852email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3853 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3854 mailers.
3855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857
3858 Arguments :
3859
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003860 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861
3862 By default the systems hostname is used.
3863
3864 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3865 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3866 for the proxy.
3867
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003868 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3869 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003870
3871
3872email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003873 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | yes
3877
3878 Arguments :
3879
3880 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3881
3882 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3883 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3884
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003885 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003886 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3887
3888
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003889force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3890 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003892 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003893
3894 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3895 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3896 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3897 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3898 marked down for maintenance operations.
3899
3900 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3901 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3902 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3903 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3904 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3905 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3906 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3907 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3908 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3909
3910 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3911 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3912 is used.
3913
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003914 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003915 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003916
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918filter <name> [param*]
3919 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3921 no | yes | yes | yes
3922 Arguments :
3923 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3924 referenced in section 9.
3925
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003926 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003927 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003928 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3929 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003930
3931 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3932 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3933
3934 Example:
3935 listen
3936 bind *:80
3937
3938 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3939 filter compression
3940 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3941
3942 compression algo gzip
3943 compression offload
3944
3945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3946
3947 See also : section 9.
3948
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950fullconn <conns>
3951 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 yes | no | yes | yes
3954 Arguments :
3955 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3956 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3957
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003958 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003960 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3962 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3963 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3964 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3965 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003966 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003967
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003968 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3969 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003970 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3971 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3972 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003974 Example :
3975 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3976 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3977 # connections.
3978 backend dynamic
3979 fullconn 10000
3980 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3981 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3982
3983 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3984
3985
3986grace <time>
3987 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 Arguments :
3991 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3992 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3993 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3994
3995 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3996 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003997 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003998 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3999
4000 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4001 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4002 simplify it.
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004005hash-balance-factor <factor>
4006 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | no | no | yes
4009 Arguments :
4010 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4011 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004012 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004013
4014 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4015 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4016 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4017 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4018 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4019 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4020 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4021
4022 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4023 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4024 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4025 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4026 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4027
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004028 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4029 consistent hashing mechanism.
4030
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004031 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4032
4033
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004034hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004035 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | no | yes | yes
4038 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004039 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4040 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004041
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004042 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4043 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4044 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4045 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4046 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4047 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4048 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4049 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4050 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4051 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004052
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004053 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4054 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4055 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4056 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4057 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4058 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4059 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4060 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4061 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4062 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4063 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4064 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4065 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004066 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4067 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004068
4069 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4070
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004071 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004072 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4073 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4074 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004075 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4076 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4077 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004078
4079 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4080 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004081 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4082 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4083 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4084 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4085
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004086 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4087 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4088 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4089 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4090 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4091 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4092 parameter.
4093
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004094 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4095 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4096 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4097 used on strings.
4098
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004099 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4100
4101 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4102 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4103 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4104 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4105 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4106 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4107 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4108 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4109 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4110 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4111 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4112 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4115 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4116 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004117
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004118 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004119
4120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121http-check disable-on-404
4122 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4128 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4129 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4130 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4131 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4132 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4133 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4134 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004135 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4136 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4137 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4138
4139 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4140
4141
4142http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004145 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146 Arguments :
4147 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4148 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004149 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004150 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4151 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4152 details on the supported keywords.
4153
4154 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4155 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4156 with the usual backslash ('\').
4157
4158 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4159 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4160 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4161 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4162 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4163
4164 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4167 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4169
4170 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004171 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4173 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4174 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4175 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4176
4177 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004178 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004179 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4180 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4181 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4182 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4183 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004185 trace).
4186
4187 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004188 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004189 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4190 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4191 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4192 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4193 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004195
4196 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4197 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4198 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4199 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4200 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4201 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4202 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4203 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4204
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004205 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4206 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4207 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4208
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4210 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4211
4212 Examples :
4213 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004214 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004215
4216 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004217 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004218
4219 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004220 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004221
4222 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004223 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004225 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226
4227
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004228http-check send-state
4229 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 yes | no | yes | yes
4232 Arguments : none
4233
4234 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4235 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4236 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4237 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4238 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4239
4240 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4241 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4242 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4243 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4244 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004245 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4246 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4247 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4248
4249 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4250 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4251 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4252
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004253 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4254 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4255 checked in multiple backends.
4256
4257 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4258 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4259
4260 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4261 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4262 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4263 one fails.
4264
4265 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4266 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4267 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4268
4269 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4270 server's queue.
4271
4272 Example of a header received by the application server :
4273 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4274 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4275
4276 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278
4279http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004280 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4281
4282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | yes
4284
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004285 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4286 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4287 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4289 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4292 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 Example:
4297 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4298 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4299 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 http-request allow if nagios
4302 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4303 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4304 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 Example:
4307 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4308 acl add path /addacl
4309 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4314 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Example:
4317 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4318 acl setmap path /setmap
4319 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4324 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4327 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4335 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4336 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4337 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4338 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4343 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4344 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4345 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4346 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4347 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4348 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4349 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4354 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4360 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4361 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4362 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4363 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 Example:
4366 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4367 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004369http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004371 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4377 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4378 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4379 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4380 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4381 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4382 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4383 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4384 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4387 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4388 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4389 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4390 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4391 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4396 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4397 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4398 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4399 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4400 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4409 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4410 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4412 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4413 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004414
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004415http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4419 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4420 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004421 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4422 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4423 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4424 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4425 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004427
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004428http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4429 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4430 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4431 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4432
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004433http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4434
4435 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4436 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4437 pointed by <resolvers>.
4438 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4439 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4440 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4441 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4442 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4443 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4444 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4445 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4446 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4447 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4448 to 0.0.0.0.
4449
4450 Example:
4451 resolvers mydns
4452 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4453 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4454 timeout retry 1s
4455 hold valid 10s
4456 hold nx 3s
4457 hold other 3s
4458 hold obsolete 0s
4459 accepted_payload_size 8192
4460
4461 frontend fe
4462 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4463 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4464 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4465
4466 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4467 # which mean DNS resolution error
4468 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4469
4470 default_backend be
4471
4472 backend b_503
4473 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4474 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4475 # 503 error page to end users
4476
4477 backend be
4478 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4479 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4480 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4481 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4482 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4483
4484 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4485 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4486
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004487http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4488
4489 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4490 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4491 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4492 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004493 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4494 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004495
4496 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004500 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4501 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4502 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4503 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4504 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4509 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4510 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4511 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004515
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004516 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4517 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4518 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4519 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4520 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4521 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004522
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004523 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4524 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4525 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4526 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4527 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004528
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004529 Example:
4530 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4531
4532 # applied to:
4533 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4534
4535 # outputs:
4536 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4537
4538 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4541
4542 # applied to:
4543 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 # outputs:
4546 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004547
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004548http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4550
4551 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4552 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4553 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4554 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4555
4556 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4557 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4558 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4559
4560 Example:
4561 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4562 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4563
4564 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4565 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4566
4567 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4568 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4569 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4570 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4571
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004572http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4574
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004575 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4576 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4577 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4578 against.
4579
4580 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4581 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4582 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004583
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004584 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4585 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4586 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4587 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4588 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4589 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4590 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4591 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4592 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004593 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4594 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004595
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004596 Example:
4597 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4598 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004599
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004600 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4601 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4604 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004606 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4607 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4608 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4609 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004610
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004611 Example:
4612 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004613
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004614 # applied to:
4615 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004616
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004617 # outputs:
4618 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004620http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4621http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4624 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4625 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004626
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004627http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4628 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004629
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004630 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4631 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4632 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4633 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4638 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4639 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4640 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4641 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 Arguments:
4644 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4645 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647 Example:
4648 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4649 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4652 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4657 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4658 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660 Arguments:
4661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4662 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 Example:
4665 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4666 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4669 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4670 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4675 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4676 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4677 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4678 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 Example:
4681 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4682 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4684 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4685 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4686 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4687 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4688 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4689 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4694 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4695 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4696 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4697 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004699http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4703 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4704 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4705 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4706 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4707 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4708 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4709 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4710 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004712http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4715 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4716 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4717 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4718 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4719 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4720 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004724 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4725 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4726 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004728http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004730 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4731 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4732 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4733 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4734 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4735 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4736 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4737 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004739http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4742 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4743 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4744 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4745 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4746 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 Example :
4749 # prepend the host name before the path
4750 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004752http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004754 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4755 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4756 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4757 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4758 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004760http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4763 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4764 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4765 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4766 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4767 values have higher priority.
4768 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4769 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4770 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4771 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4772 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004774http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004776 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4777 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4778 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4779 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4780 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4781 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4782 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004784 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004785
4786 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004787 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4788 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004790http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4792 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4793 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4794 privacy.
4795
4796 Arguments :
4797 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4798 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004799
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004800 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004801 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4802 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4803
4804 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4805 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4806
4807http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4808
4809 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4810 expression.
4811
4812 Arguments:
4813 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4814 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004815
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004816 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004817 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4818 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4819
4820 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4821 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4822 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4823
4824http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4825
4826 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4827 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4828 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4829 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4830 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4831 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4832 information from the request.
4833
4834 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4835
4836http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4837
4838 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4839 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4840 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4841 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4842 path and the query string.
4843 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4844
4845http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4846
4847 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4848 inline.
4849
4850 Arguments:
4851 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4852 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4856 (request and response)
4857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4858 processing
4859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4860 processing
4861 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4862 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4863 and '_'.
4864
4865 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4866 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004867
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004868 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004869 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004871http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004874 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4875 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4876 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4877 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4878 agent name must be used.
4879
4880 Arguments:
4881 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4882
4883 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4884 configuration.
4885
4886http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4887
4888 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4889 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4890 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4891 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4892 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4893 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4894 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4895 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4896 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4897 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4898 action.
4899 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4900 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4901 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4902 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4903 you fully understand how it works.
4904
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004905http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4906
4907 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4908 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4909 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4910 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4911 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4912 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4913 processing.
4914
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004915 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004916 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4917 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4918 rules evaluation.
4919
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004920http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4921 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004922
4923 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4924 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4925 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4926 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4927 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4928 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4929 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4930 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4931 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4932 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4933 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004934 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
4935 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4936 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4937 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4938 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004939 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4940
4941http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4942http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944
4945 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4946 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4947 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4948 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4949 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4950 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4951 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4952 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4953 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4954 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4955 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4956 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4957
4958 Arguments :
4959 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4960 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4961 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4962 select which table entry to update the counters.
4963
4964 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4965 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4966 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4967 that table until the session ends.
4968
4969 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4970 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4971 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4972 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4973 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4974 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4975 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4976 useful information.
4977
4978 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4979 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4980 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4981 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4982 checks that make use of it.
4983
4984http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4985
4986 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004987
4988 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004990
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004991http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4992
4993 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4994 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4995 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4996 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4997 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4998 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4999
5000 Arguments :
5001 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5002
5003 Example:
5004 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005008 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5009 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5010 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005011
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005014 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5015
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 no | yes | yes | yes
5018
5019 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5020 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5021 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5022 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5023 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5024 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005026 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5027 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 Example:
5032 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5037 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039 Example:
5040 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005044 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5045 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5048 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005050http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5053 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5054 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5055 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5056 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5057 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5058 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5059 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5064 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5065 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5066 example, or to pass some internal information.
5067 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5068 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5069 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5074 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005076http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005078 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005080http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005082 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5083 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5084 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5085 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5086 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5087 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5088 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5091 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5092 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5093 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5094 keyword.
5095 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5096 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5101 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5102 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5103 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5104 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5105 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005109 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005111http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5114 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5115 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5116 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5117 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5118 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005119
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005120http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005123 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005124 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5125 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005126 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5127 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5128 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5129 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5130 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005131 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005133http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005135 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5136 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5137 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5138 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5139 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5140 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005142http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5143 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005144
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005145 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5146 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005148 Example:
5149 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005151 # applied to:
5152 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005154 # outputs:
5155 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005161
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005162 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005163 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005165 Example:
5166 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005168 # applied to:
5169 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005171 # outputs:
5172 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005174http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5175http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005177 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5178 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5179 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005180
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005181http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5182 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005183
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005184 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5185 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5186 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5187 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005189http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5192 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5193 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5194 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5195 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005197 Arguments:
5198 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005200 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5201 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005203http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5206 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5207 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005209http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5210
5211 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5212 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5213 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5214 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5215 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5216
5217http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5218
5219 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5220 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5221 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5222 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5223 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5224 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5225 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5226 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5227 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5228
5229http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5230
5231 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5232 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5233 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5234 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5235 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5236 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5237 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5238
5239http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5240
5241 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5242 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5243 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5244 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5245 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5246 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5247 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5248 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5249
5250http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252
5253 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5254 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5255 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5256 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005257
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005258 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005259 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5260 http-response set-status 431
5261 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5262 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005263
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005264http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005266 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5267 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5268 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5269 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5270 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5271 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5272 based on some information from the request.
5273
5274 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5275
5276http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5277
5278 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5279 inline.
5280
5281 Arguments:
5282 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5283 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5284 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5285 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5286 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5287 (request and response)
5288 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5289 processing
5290 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5291 processing
5292 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5293 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5294 and '_'.
5295
5296 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5297 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005298
5299 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005300 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005302http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005304 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5305 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5306 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5307 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5308 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5309 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5310 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5311 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5312 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5313 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5314 action.
5315 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5316 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5317 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5318 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5319 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005320
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005321http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5322
5323 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5324 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5325 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5326 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5327 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5328 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5329 processing.
5330
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005331 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005332 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5333 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5334 rules evaluation.
5335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005336http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5337http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5338http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005340 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5341 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5342 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5343 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5344 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5345 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5346
5347http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5348
5349 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5350 about <var-name>.
5351
5352 Example:
5353 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5354
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005355
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005356http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5357 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5358
5359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
5361
5362 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005363 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5364 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5365 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005366
5367 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5368
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005369 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5370 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5371 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5372 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5373 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5374 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5375 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5376 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5377 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5378 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005379
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005380 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5381 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5382 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5383 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5384 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5385 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5386 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5387 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005388
5389 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5390 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5391 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5392 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5393 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5394 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5395 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5396 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005397 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005398 downsides of rare connection failures.
5399
5400 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5401 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5402 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5403 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5404 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5405 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005406 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005407 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5408 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5409 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5410 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5411 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5412
5413 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005414 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5415 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5416 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005417
5418 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005419 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005420
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005421 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5422 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005423
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005424 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005425
5426 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5427 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5428 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5429
5430 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5431
5432
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005433http-send-name-header [<header>]
5434 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005437 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005438 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5439
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005440 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5441 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5442 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5443 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5444 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5445 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5446 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5447 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5448 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5449 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5450 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5451 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5452 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5453 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5454 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5455 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005456
5457 See also : "server"
5458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005459id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005460 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 no | yes | yes | yes
5463 Arguments : none
5464
5465 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5466 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5467 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005468
5469
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005470ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5471 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005473 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005474
5475 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5476 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5477 and running).
5478
5479 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5480 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5481 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005482 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005483 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5484
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005485 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5486 "unless" condition is met.
5487
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005488 Example:
5489 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5490 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5491 ignore-persist if url_static
5492
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005493 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5494
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005495load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5496 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5498 yes | no | yes | yes
5499
5500 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5501 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5502 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005503 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005504 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5505 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5506 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5507 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5508
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005509 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005510 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005511 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005512
5513 Arguments:
5514 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5515 named "server-state-file".
5516
5517 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5518 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5519 name is used as a file name.
5520
5521 none don't load any stat for this backend
5522
5523 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005524 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5525 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5526 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005527 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005528 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005529
5530 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5531 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005533 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005535 global
5536 stats socket /tmp/socket
5537 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005538
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005539 defaults
5540 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005542 backend bk
5543 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5544 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005545
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005546
5547 Then one can run :
5548
5549 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5550
5551 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5552
5553 1
5554 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5555 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5556 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5557
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005558 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005559
5560 global
5561 stats socket /tmp/socket
5562 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5563
5564 defaults
5565 load-server-state-from-file local
5566
5567 backend bk
5568 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5569 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5570
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005571
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005572 Then one can run :
5573
5574 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5575
5576 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5577
5578 1
5579 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5580 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5581 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5582
5583 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5584 "show servers state"
5585
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005587log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005588log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5589 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005590no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005591 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5593 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005594
5595 Prefix :
5596 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5597 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5598 prefix does not allow arguments.
5599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005600 Arguments :
5601 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5602 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5603 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5604 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5605 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5606 parameter.
5607
5608 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5609 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5610
5611 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5612 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5613 standard syslog port).
5614
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005615 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5616 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5617 standard syslog port).
5618
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005619 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5620 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5621 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005622 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005624 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5625 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5626 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5627 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5628 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5629 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5630 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5631 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5632 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5633 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5634 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5635 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5636 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5637 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5638 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5639 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005640 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5641 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005642
5643 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5644 and "fd@2", see above.
5645
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005646 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5647 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5648 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5649 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5650 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5651 having the logs instantly available.
5652
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005653 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5654 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005655
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005656 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5657 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5658 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5659 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5660 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5661 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5662 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5663 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5664 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5665 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005666 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005667
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005668 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5669 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5670 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5671 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5672 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5673
5674 <sample_size>
5675 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5676 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5677 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5678 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5679 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5680
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005681 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5682 one of the following :
5683
5684 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5685 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5686
5687 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5688 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5689
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005690 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5691 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5692 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5693 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5694 systemd logger consumes.
5695
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005696 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5697 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5698 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5699 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005701 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5702
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005703 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5704 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5705 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5706
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005707 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5708 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5709 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5710 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005711
5712 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5713 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5714 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005715 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5716 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5717 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5718 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5719 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005720
5721 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5722
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005723 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5724 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5725 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005726
5727 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5728 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5729 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5730 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5731
5732 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5733 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005734
5735 Example :
5736 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005737 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5738 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5739 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005740 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5741 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005742 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005743
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005744
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005745log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005746 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005749
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005750 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5751 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5752 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5753 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5754 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005755
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005756 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5757 "option httplog" directives.
5758
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005759log-format-sd <string>
5760 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 yes | yes | yes | no
5763
5764 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5765 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5766 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5767 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5768 which covers the log format string in depth.
5769
5770 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5771 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5772
5773 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5774 log format to "rfc5424".
5775
5776 Example :
5777 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5778
5779
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005780log-tag <string>
5781 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | yes | yes | yes
5784
5785 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5786 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5787 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5788 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5789 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5790 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5791 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5792 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5793 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005794
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005795max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5796 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | no | yes | yes
5799
5800 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5801 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5802 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5803 servers.
5804
5805 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5806 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5807 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5808 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5809 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005810 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005811 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5812 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5813 picking a different server.
5814
5815 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5816 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5817 even if they have to be queued.
5818
5819 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5820 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5821
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005822max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5823 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5824 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5825 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005826
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005827maxconn <conns>
5828 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5830 yes | yes | yes | no
5831 Arguments :
5832 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5833 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5834 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5835 closes.
5836
5837 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5838 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5839 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5840 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005841 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5842 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5843 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5844 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005845
5846 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5847 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5848 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5849
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005850 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5851 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005853 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5854
5855
5856mode { tcp|http|health }
5857 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 yes | yes | yes | yes
5860 Arguments :
5861 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5862 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5863 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5864 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5865
5866 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5867 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5868 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5869 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5870 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5871
5872 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005873 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5874 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5875 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5876 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5877 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5878 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5879 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005880
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005881 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5882 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5883 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005884
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005885 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005886 defaults http_instances
5887 mode http
5888
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005889 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005891
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005892monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005893 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005896 Arguments :
5897 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5898 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005899 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005900 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5901 backend and its backup.
5902
5903 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5904 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5905 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5906 servers in a list of backends.
5907
5908 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5909 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5910 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5911 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5912 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5913 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5914 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005915 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5916 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005917
5918 Example:
5919 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005920 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005921 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5922 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5923 monitor-uri /site_alive
5924 monitor fail if site_dead
5925
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005926 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927
5928
5929monitor-net <source>
5930 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | no
5933 Arguments :
5934 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5935 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5936 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5937 followed by a mask.
5938
5939 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5940 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005941 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005942 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5943
5944 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5945 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5946 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5947 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005948 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5949 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5950 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005951
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005952 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5953 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5954 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5955 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5956 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5957 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005958
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005959 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5960 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005962 Example :
5963 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5964 frontend www
5965 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5966
5967 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5968
5969
5970monitor-uri <uri>
5971 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 yes | yes | yes | no
5974 Arguments :
5975 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5976 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5977
5978 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5979 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5980 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5981 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5982 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5983 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5984 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5985 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5986
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005987 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005988 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5989 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5990 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5991 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5992 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5993 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005994
5995 Example :
5996 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5997 frontend www
5998 mode http
5999 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6000
6001 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006003
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006004option abortonclose
6005no option abortonclose
6006 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | no | yes | yes
6009 Arguments : none
6010
6011 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6012 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6013 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6014 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006015 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006016 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6017 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6018 encountered while delivering the response.
6019
6020 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6021 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6022 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6023 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6024 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6025 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006026 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006027 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006028 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6030 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6031 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6032
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006033 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6034 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006035 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6036 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6037 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6038 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6039 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6040 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006041 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006042
6043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6045
6046 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6047
6048
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006049option accept-invalid-http-request
6050no option accept-invalid-http-request
6051 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6053 yes | yes | yes | no
6054 Arguments : none
6055
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006056 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006057 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006058 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006059 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6060 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6061 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6062 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6063 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006064 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6065 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6066 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6067 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006068 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006069 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006070 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6071 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6072 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006073
6074 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6075 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6076 been confirmed.
6077
6078 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6079 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006080 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6081 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006082 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6083
6084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6086
6087 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6088 stats socket.
6089
6090
6091option accept-invalid-http-response
6092no option accept-invalid-http-response
6093 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | yes | yes
6096 Arguments : none
6097
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006098 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006099 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006100 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006101 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6102 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6103 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6104 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6105 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006106 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6107 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6108 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006109
6110 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6111 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6112 been confirmed.
6113
6114 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6115 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6116 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6117 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6118
6119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6121
6122 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6123 stats socket.
6124
6125
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006126option allbackups
6127no option allbackups
6128 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | no | yes | yes
6131 Arguments : none
6132
6133 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6134 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6135 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6136 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6137 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6138 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6139 order between the backup servers anymore.
6140
6141 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6142 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6143
6144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6146
6147
6148option checkcache
6149no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006150 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6152 yes | no | yes | yes
6153 Arguments : none
6154
6155 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6156 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006157 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006158 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6159 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006160 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006161
6162 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006163 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006164 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006165 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6166 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006167 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006168 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006169 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6170 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006171 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006172 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6173 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006174 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006175 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6176 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6177 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6178 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6179 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6180 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6181 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6182 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6183 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6184
6185 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006186 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6187 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6188 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6189 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006190
6191 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6192 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006193 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006194 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006195
6196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6198
6199
6200option clitcpka
6201no option clitcpka
6202 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6204 yes | yes | yes | no
6205 Arguments : none
6206
6207 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6208 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006209 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006210 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6211
6212 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6213 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6214 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6215 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6216
6217 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6218 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6219 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6220 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6221 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6222
6223 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6224
6225 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6226 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6227 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6228
6229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6231
6232 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6233
6234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006235option contstats
6236 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6238 yes | yes | yes | no
6239 Arguments : none
6240
6241 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6242 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6243 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6244 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006245 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6246 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6247 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6248 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6249 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006250
6251
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006252option dontlog-normal
6253no option dontlog-normal
6254 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6256 yes | yes | yes | no
6257 Arguments : none
6258
6259 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6260 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6261 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6262 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6263 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6264 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6265 logged.
6266
6267 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6268 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6269 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006271 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006272 logging.
6273
6274
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006275option dontlognull
6276no option dontlognull
6277 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | yes | yes | no
6280 Arguments : none
6281
6282 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6283 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6284 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6285 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6286 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6287 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006288 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6289 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6290 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006291
6292 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006293 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006294 would not be logged.
6295
6296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6298
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006299 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6300 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006301
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006302
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006303option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006304 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | yes | yes | yes
6307 Arguments :
6308 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6309 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006310 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006311 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006312
6313 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6314 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6315 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6316 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6317 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6318 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6319 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006320 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6321 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6322 possible that the client has already brought one.
6323
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006324 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006325 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006326 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006327 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006328 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006329 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006330
6331 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6332 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6333 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6334 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6335 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6336 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6337 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6338
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006339 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6340 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6341 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6342 are under the control of the end-user.
6343
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006344 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006345 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6346 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006347 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6348 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6349 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006350
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006351 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006352 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6353 frontend www
6354 mode http
6355 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6356
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006357 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6358 backend www
6359 mode http
6360 option forwardfor header X-Client
6361
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006362 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006363 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006364
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006365
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006366option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6367no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6368 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6370 yes | yes | yes | no
6371 Arguments : none
6372
6373 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6374 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6375 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6376 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6377 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6378 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6379 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6380
6381 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6382 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6383 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6384 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6385 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6386 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6387 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6388 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6389 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6390 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6391
6392 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6393
6394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6396
6397 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6398 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6399
6400
6401option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6402no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6403 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | no | yes | yes
6406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6409 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6410 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6411 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6412 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6413 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6414 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6415
6416 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6417 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6418 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6419 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6420 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6421 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6422 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6423 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6424 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6425 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6426
6427 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6428
6429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6431
6432 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6433 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6434
6435
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006436option http-buffer-request
6437no option http-buffer-request
6438 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6440 yes | yes | yes | yes
6441 Arguments : none
6442
6443 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6444 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6445 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6446 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6447 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6448 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006449 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6450 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6451 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6452 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006453
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006454 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006455
6456
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006457option http-ignore-probes
6458no option http-ignore-probes
6459 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6461 yes | yes | yes | no
6462 Arguments : none
6463
6464 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6465 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6466 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6467 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6468 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6469 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6470 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6471 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6472 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006473 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6474 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006475 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6476
6477 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6478 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6479 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6480 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6481 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6482 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6483 are often the only way to detect them.
6484
6485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6487
6488 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6489
6490
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006491option http-keep-alive
6492no option http-keep-alive
6493 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | yes | yes | yes
6496 Arguments : none
6497
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006498 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6499 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006500 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6501 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006502 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6503 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6504 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006505
6506 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6507 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006508 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6509 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6510 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6511 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6512 situations where this option may be useful :
6513
6514 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006515 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006516
6517 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6518 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6519
6520 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6521 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6522 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6523 request.
6524
6525 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6526 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006527 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6528 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6529 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006530
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006531 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6532 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6533 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6534 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6535 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6536 not set.
6537
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006538 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6539 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6540 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006541
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006542 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006543 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006544 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006545
6546
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006547option http-no-delay
6548no option http-no-delay
6549 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | yes
6552 Arguments : none
6553
6554 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6555 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6556 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6557 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6558 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6559 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6560 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6561 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6562 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6563 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6564 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6565 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6566 affected.
6567
6568 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6569 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6570 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6571 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6572 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6573 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6574 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6575 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6576 latency environments.
6577
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006578 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6579
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006580
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006581option http-pretend-keepalive
6582no option http-pretend-keepalive
6583 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006585 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006586 Arguments : none
6587
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006588 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006589 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6590 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6591 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6592 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6593 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6594 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6595 consider the response complete.
6596
6597 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6598 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6599 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6600 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006601 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006602 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6603
6604 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6605 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6606 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6607 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6608 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6609 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6610 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6611
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006612 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6613 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6614 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6615 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6616 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6617 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006618
6619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6621
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006622 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006623 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006624
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006625
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006626option http-server-close
6627no option http-server-close
6628 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6630 yes | yes | yes | yes
6631 Arguments : none
6632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6634 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6635 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6636 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006637 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6638 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6639 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6640 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6641 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6642 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6643 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6644 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6645 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6646 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6647 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006648
6649 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6650 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6651 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6652 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006653 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6654 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006655
6656 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6657 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006658 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6659 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6660 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006661
6662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6664
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006665 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6666 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006667
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006668option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006669no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006670 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | yes | yes | no
6673 Arguments : none
6674
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006675 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006676 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6677 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6678 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6679 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6680 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6681 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6682
6683 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6684 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006685 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6686 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6687 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006688
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006689 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6690 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6691 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6692 front of an existing proxy.
6693
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006694 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6695
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006696 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006697
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006698option httpchk
6699option httpchk <uri>
6700option httpchk <method> <uri>
6701option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6702 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6704 yes | no | yes | yes
6705 Arguments :
6706 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6707 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6708 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6709 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6710 ones.
6711
6712 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6713 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6714 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6715
6716 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6717 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6718 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6719 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6720 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6721
6722 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6723 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6724 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6725 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6726 the lack of any response.
6727
6728 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6729
6730 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6731 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6732 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6733
6734 Examples :
6735 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6736 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6737 backend https_relay
6738 mode tcp
6739 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6740 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6741
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006742 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6743 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6744 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006745
6746
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006747option httpclose
6748no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006749 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6751 yes | yes | yes | yes
6752 Arguments : none
6753
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006754 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6755 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6756 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6757 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006758 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006759
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006760 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6761 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006762 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006763 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6764 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006765
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006766 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6767 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6768 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006769
6770 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6771 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006772 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6773 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6774 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006775
6776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6778
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006779 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006780
6781
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006782option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006783 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006785 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006786 Arguments :
6787 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6788 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6789 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006790 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006791 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006792
6793 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6794 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6795 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6796 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6797 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6798 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6799 ports.
6800
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006801 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6802 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006803
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006804 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006806 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006808
6809option http_proxy
6810no option http_proxy
6811 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 yes | yes | yes | yes
6814 Arguments : none
6815
6816 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6817 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6818 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6819 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6820 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6821
6822 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6823 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006824 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6825 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006826
6827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6829
6830 Example :
6831 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6832 backend direct_forward
6833 option httpclose
6834 option http_proxy
6835
6836 See also : "option httpclose"
6837
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006838
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006839option independent-streams
6840no option independent-streams
6841 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | yes | yes | yes
6844 Arguments : none
6845
6846 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6847 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6848 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6849 receive data or not.
6850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006852 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6853 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6854 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6855 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6856 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6857 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6858 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6859 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6860 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6861 socket buffers.
6862
6863 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6864 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6865 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6866 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6867 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6868
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006869 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006870
6871
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006872option ldap-check
6873 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | no | yes | yes
6876 Arguments : none
6877
6878 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6879 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6880 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6881 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6882
6883 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6884 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6885
6886 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6887 configure it.
6888
6889 Example :
6890 option ldap-check
6891
6892 See also : "option httpchk"
6893
6894
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006895option external-check
6896 Use external processes for server health checks
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | no | yes | yes
6899
6900 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6901 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6902 command".
6903
6904 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6905
6906 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6907
6908
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006909option log-health-checks
6910no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006911 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6913 yes | no | yes | yes
6914 Arguments : none
6915
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006916 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6917 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6918 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006919
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006920 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6921 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6922 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6923 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6924 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6925
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006926 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006927 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006928
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006929 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6930 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6931 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006932
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006933
6934option log-separate-errors
6935no option log-separate-errors
6936 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 yes | yes | yes | no
6939 Arguments : none
6940
6941 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6942 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6943 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6944 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6945 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6946 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6947 provides very important information.
6948
6949 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6950 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6951 error logs.
6952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006954 logging.
6955
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006956
6957option logasap
6958no option logasap
6959 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 yes | yes | yes | no
6962 Arguments : none
6963
6964 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6965 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6966 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6967 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6968 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6969 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6970 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006971 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006972 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6973 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006975 Examples :
6976 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6977 mode http
6978 option httplog
6979 option logasap
6980 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6981
6982 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6983 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6984 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6985 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006987 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006988 logging.
6989
6990
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006991option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006992 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006995 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006996 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6997 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006998 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006999
7000 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7001 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007003 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7004 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7005 in the MySQL table, like this :
7006
7007 USE mysql;
7008 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7009 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7010
7011 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007012 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007013 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7014 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7015 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7016 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7017 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7018 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7019 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7020
7021 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7022 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007023
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007024 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007025
7026 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7027 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7028 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7029 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007030 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7031 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007032
7033 See also: "option httpchk"
7034
7035
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007036option nolinger
7037no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007038 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007039 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7040 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007041 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007042
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007043 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007044 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7045 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7046 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7047 connections.
7048
7049 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7050 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7051 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7052 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7053 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7054 this too.
7055
7056 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7057 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7058 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7059
7060 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7061 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7062 for servers.
7063
7064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7066
7067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007068option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7069 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 yes | yes | yes | yes
7072 Arguments :
7073 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7074 matching <network>
7075 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7076 header name.
7077
7078 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7079 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7080 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7081 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7082 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7083 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7084 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7085 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7086 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7087 possible that the client has already brought one.
7088
7089 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7090 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7091 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7092 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7093 header and requires different one.
7094
7095 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7096 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7097 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7098 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7099 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7100 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7101 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7102
7103 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7104 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7105 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7106 both are defined.
7107
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007108 Examples :
7109 # Original Destination address
7110 frontend www
7111 mode http
7112 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7113
7114 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7115 backend www
7116 mode http
7117 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7118
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007119 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007120
7121
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007122option persist
7123no option persist
7124 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007127 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007128
7129 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7130 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7131 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7132 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7133 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7134 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7135 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7136 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7137 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7138 redirected to another valid server.
7139
7140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7142
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007143 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007144
7145
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007146option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7147 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 yes | no | yes | yes
7150 Arguments :
7151 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7152 PostgreSQL server.
7153
7154 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7155 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7156 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7157 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7158
7159 See also: "option httpchk"
7160
7161
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007162option prefer-last-server
7163no option prefer-last-server
7164 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | no | yes | yes
7167 Arguments : none
7168
7169 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7170 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7171 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7172 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7173 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7174 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7175 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7176 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7177 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007178 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7179 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007180 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7181 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7182 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007183 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7184 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7185 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007186
7187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7189
7190 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7191
7192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007193option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007194option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007195no option redispatch
7196 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007199 Arguments :
7200 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7201 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7202 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007203 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007204 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007205 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007206 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7207 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7208 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007210
7211 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7212 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7213 be able to access the service anymore.
7214
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007215 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7216 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007217
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007218 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007219 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7220 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7224
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007225 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007227
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007228option redis-check
7229 Use redis health checks for server testing
7230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7231 yes | no | yes | yes
7232 Arguments : none
7233
7234 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7235 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7236 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7237 find the "+PONG" response message.
7238
7239 Example :
7240 option redis-check
7241
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007242 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007243
7244
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007245option smtpchk
7246option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7247 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007251 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007252 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007253 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7254
7255 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7256 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7257 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7258
7259 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7260 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7261 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7262 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7263 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7264 dead server.
7265
7266 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7267 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007268 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007269 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7270
7271 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7272 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7273 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7274 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007275 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007276
7277 Example :
7278 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7279
7280 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007283option socket-stats
7284no option socket-stats
7285
7286 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7288 yes | yes | yes | no
7289
7290 Arguments : none
7291
7292
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007293option splice-auto
7294no option splice-auto
7295 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | yes | yes | yes
7298 Arguments : none
7299
7300 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7301 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007302 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007303 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007304 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007305 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7306 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7307 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7308 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7309
7310 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7311 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7312 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7313 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7314 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7315 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7316 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7317 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7318 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7319 keyword.
7320
7321 Example :
7322 option splice-auto
7323
7324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7326
7327 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7328 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7329
7330
7331option splice-request
7332no option splice-request
7333 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 yes | yes | yes | yes
7336 Arguments : none
7337
7338 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007339 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007340 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7341 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7342 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7343 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7344
7345 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7346
7347 Example :
7348 option splice-request
7349
7350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7352
7353 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7354 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7355
7356
7357option splice-response
7358no option splice-response
7359 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7361 yes | yes | yes | yes
7362 Arguments : none
7363
7364 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007365 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007366 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7367 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7368 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7369 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7370
7371 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7372
7373 Example :
7374 option splice-response
7375
7376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7378
7379 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7380 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7381
7382
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007383option spop-check
7384 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7386 no | no | no | yes
7387 Arguments : none
7388
7389 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7390 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7391 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7392 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7393
7394 Example :
7395 option spop-check
7396
7397 See also : "option httpchk"
7398
7399
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007400option srvtcpka
7401no option srvtcpka
7402 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7404 yes | no | yes | yes
7405 Arguments : none
7406
7407 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7408 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007409 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007410 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7411
7412 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7413 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7414 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7415 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7416
7417 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7418 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7419 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7420 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7421 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7422
7423 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7424
7425 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7426 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7427 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7428
7429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7431
7432 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7433
7434
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007435option ssl-hello-chk
7436 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 yes | no | yes | yes
7439 Arguments : none
7440
7441 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7442 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7443 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7444 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7445 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7446 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7447 hello message.
7448
7449 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7450 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7451 messages, which is appreciable.
7452
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007453 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7454 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7455 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007456
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007457 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7458
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007459
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007460option tcp-check
7461 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 yes | no | yes | yes
7464
7465 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7466 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7467
7468 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7469 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7470 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7471
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007472 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007473 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7474 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7475 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7476 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7477 only.
7478
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007479 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007480 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7481 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7482 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7483 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7484
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007485 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007486 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7487 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007488 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007489 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7490 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7491 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7492 the respective protocols.
7493 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007495
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007496 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7497 script.
7498
7499 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7500 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7501 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7502 The "comment" is of course optional.
7503
7504
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007505 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007506 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007507 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007508 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007511 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007512 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007513
7514 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7515 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007517 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007518 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007519 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007520 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007521 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007522 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7523 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007524 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007525 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7526 tcp-check expect string +OK
7527
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007529 (send many headers before analyzing)
7530 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007531 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007532 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7533 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7534 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7535 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007536 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007537
7538
7539 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7540
7541
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007542option tcp-smart-accept
7543no option tcp-smart-accept
7544 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 yes | yes | yes | no
7547 Arguments : none
7548
7549 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7550 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7551 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7552 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7553 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7554 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7555
7556 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7557 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7558 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7559 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7560
7561 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7562 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7563 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007564 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007565
7566 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7567 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7568 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7569
7570 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7571 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7572 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7573
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007574 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7575
7576
7577option tcp-smart-connect
7578no option tcp-smart-connect
7579 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 yes | no | yes | yes
7582 Arguments : none
7583
7584 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7585 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7586 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7587 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7588 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7589
7590 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7591 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7592 complex.
7593
7594 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7595 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7596 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7597
7598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7600
7601 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7602
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007603
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007604option tcpka
7605 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 yes | yes | yes | yes
7608 Arguments : none
7609
7610 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7611 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007612 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007613 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7614
7615 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7616 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7617 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7618 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7619
7620 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7621 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7622 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7623 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7624 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7625
7626 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7627
7628 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7629 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7630 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7631 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7632 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7633 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7634 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7635 backends.
7636
7637 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7638
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007639
7640option tcplog
7641 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007643 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007644 Arguments : none
7645
7646 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7647 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7648 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7649 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7650 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7651 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7652 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7653 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7654
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007655 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007657 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007658
7659
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007660option transparent
7661no option transparent
7662 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007664 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007665 Arguments : none
7666
7667 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7668 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7669 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7670 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7671 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7672 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7673 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7674 appropriate server.
7675
7676 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7677 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7678
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007679 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007680 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007681
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007683external-check command <command>
7684 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7686 yes | no | yes | yes
7687
7688 Arguments :
7689 <command> is the external command to run
7690
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007691 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7692
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007693 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007694
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007695 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7696 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7697 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7698 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7699 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7700 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007701
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007702 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7703
7704 Environment variables :
7705 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7706 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7707
7708 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7709
7710 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7711
7712 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7713 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7714 for a UNIX socket).
7715
7716 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7717
7718 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7719
7720 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7721
7722 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7723
7724 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7725
7726 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7727 socket).
7728
7729 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7730 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007732 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7733
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007734 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7735 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7736 failed.
7737
7738 Example :
7739 external-check command /bin/true
7740
7741 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7742
7743
7744external-check path <path>
7745 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | no | yes | yes
7748
7749 Arguments :
7750 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7751
7752 The default path is "".
7753
7754 Example :
7755 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7756
7757 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7758 "external-check command"
7759
7760
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007761persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007762persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007763 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7765 yes | no | yes | yes
7766 Arguments :
7767 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007768 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7769 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007770
7771 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7772 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007773 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007774 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7775 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7776 forwarded to this server.
7777
7778 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7779 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7780 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007781 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007782 a single "listen" section.
7783
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007784 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7785 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7786 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7787
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007788 Example :
7789 listen tse-farm
7790 bind :3389
7791 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7792 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7793 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7794 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7795 persist rdp-cookie
7796 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007797 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007798 balance rdp-cookie
7799 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7800 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7801
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007802 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7803 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007804
7805
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007806rate-limit sessions <rate>
7807 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7809 yes | yes | yes | no
7810 Arguments :
7811 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7812 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7813
7814 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7815 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7816 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7817 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7818 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7819 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7820
7821 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7822 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7823 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7824 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7825
7826 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7827 listen smtp
7828 mode tcp
7829 bind :25
7830 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007831 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007832
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007833 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7834 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7835 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007836
7837 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7838
7839
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007840redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7841redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7842redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007843 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 no | yes | yes | yes
7846
7847 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007848 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007849
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007850 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007851 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007852 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7853 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7854 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007855
7856 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7857 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7858 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7859 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7860 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007861 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7862 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7863 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7864 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007865
7866 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7867 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7868 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7869 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7870 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7871 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007872 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007873 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007874 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7875 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7876 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007877
7878 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007879 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7880 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7881 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007882 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007883 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7884 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7885 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7886 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007887
7888 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007889 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007890
7891 - "drop-query"
7892 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7893 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7894 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7895 with a location-type redirect.
7896
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007897 - "append-slash"
7898 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7899 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7900 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7901 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7902
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007903 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7904 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7905 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7906 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7907 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7908 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7909 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7910
7911 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7912 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7913 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7914 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7915 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7916 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7917 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007918
7919 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7920 acl clear dst_port 80
7921 acl secure dst_port 8080
7922 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007923 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007924 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007925 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7926
7927 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007928 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7929 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7930 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007931 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007932
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007933 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7934 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7935 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7936
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007937 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007938 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007939
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007940 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007941 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7942 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7943 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007945 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007946
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007947
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007948retries <value>
7949 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952 Arguments :
7953 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7954 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7955 default value is 3.
7956
7957 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7958 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7959 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7960
7961 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007962 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7963 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007964
7965 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7966 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7967
7968 See also : "option redispatch"
7969
7970
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007971retry-on [list of keywords]
7972 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | no | yes | yes
7975 Arguments :
7976 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7977 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7978 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7979 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7980
7981 none never retry
7982
7983 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7984 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7985
7986 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7987 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7988 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7989 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7990 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7991 processing the request.
7992
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007993 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7994 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7995 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7996 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7997 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7998 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7999 overflow attack for example).
8000
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008001 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8002 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8003 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8004 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8005 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8006 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8007 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8008 amplify denial of service attacks.
8009
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008010 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8011 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8012 considered to be safe to retry.
8013
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008014 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8015 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8016 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8017 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8018
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008019 all-retryable-errors
8020 retry request for any error that are considered
8021 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8022 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8023 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8024
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008025 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8026 not cumulative.
8027
8028 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8029 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8030 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8031 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8032
8033 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8034 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8035 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8036 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8037 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8038 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8039 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8040 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8041 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8042 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8043 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8044 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8045
8046 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8047 should not use this directive.
8048
8049 The default is "conn-failure".
8050
8051 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8052
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008053server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054 Declare a server in a backend
8055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8056 no | no | yes | yes
8057 Arguments :
8058 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008059 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008060 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008061
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008062 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8063 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8064 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8065 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008066 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8067 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8068 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8069 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8070 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008071 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8072 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8073 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8074 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8075 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8076 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8077 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008078 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008079 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8080 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8081 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8082 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8083 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8084 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008085 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8086 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008087 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8088 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008090 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8092 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8093 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8094 adding this value to the client's port.
8095
8096 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8097 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008098 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008099
8100 Examples :
8101 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8102 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008103 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008104 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8105 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8106 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008107
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008108 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8109 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8110 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8111 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8112 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8113
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008114 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8115 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008116
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008117server-state-file-name [<file>]
8118 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8119 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8120 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8121 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8122 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8123 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8124
8125 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8126 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8127
8128 global
8129 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8130
8131 backend bk
8132 load-server-state-from-file
8133
8134 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8135 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008136
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008137server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8138 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8139 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8141 no | no | yes | yes
8142
8143 Arguments:
8144 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8145
8146 <num | range>
8147 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8148 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8149 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8150 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8151
8152 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8153
8154 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8155
8156 <params*>
8157 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8158 keyword.
8159
8160 Examples:
8161 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8162 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8163 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8164
8165 # or
8166 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8167
8168 # would be equivalent to:
8169 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8170 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8171 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8172
8173
8174
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008175source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008176source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008177source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008178 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 yes | no | yes | yes
8181 Arguments :
8182 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8183 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008184
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008185 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008186 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8187 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8188 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8189 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8190 supported prefixes are :
8191 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8192 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8193 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008194 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008195 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8196 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008197
8198 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8199 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008200 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8201 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8202 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008203
8204 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8205 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8206 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8207 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8208 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8209 <addr>.
8210
8211 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8212 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8213 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8214 port.
8215
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008216 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8217 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8218 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8219 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008220 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008221 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8222 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8223 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8224 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8225 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8226 HTTP header.
8227
8228 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8229 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008230 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008231 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8232 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8233 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8234 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8235 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8236 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8237 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8238
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008239 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8240 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8241 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8242 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8243 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8244 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8245
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008246 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8247 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8248 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8249 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8250
8251 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8252 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8253 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8254 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8255 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8256 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8257
8258 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8259 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8260 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8261 there are two methods :
8262
8263 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8264 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8265 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8266 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8267 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8268 of the client ranges may be used.
8269
8270 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8271 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8272 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8273 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8274 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8275 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8276 same session.
8277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8279 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8280 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008281 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008282
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008283 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8284
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008285 Examples :
8286 backend private
8287 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8288 source 192.168.1.200
8289
8290 backend transparent_ssl1
8291 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8292 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8293
8294 backend transparent_ssl2
8295 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8296 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8297 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8298
8299 backend transparent_ssl3
8300 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8301 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8302 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8303
8304 backend transparent_smtp
8305 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8306 # with Tproxy version 4.
8307 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8308
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008309 backend transparent_http
8310 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8311 # proxy.
8312 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008314 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008315 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8316
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008317
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008318stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8319 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008321 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008322
8323 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8324 matched.
8325
8326 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8327 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8328
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008329 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8330 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008331 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008332
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008333 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8334 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8335 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8336 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008337
8338 Example :
8339 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8340 backend stats_localhost
8341 stats enable
8342 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8343
8344 Example :
8345 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8346 backend stats_auth
8347 stats enable
8348 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8349 stats admin if TRUE
8350
8351 Example :
8352 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8353 userlist stats-auth
8354 group admin users admin
8355 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8356 group readonly users haproxy
8357 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8358
8359 backend stats_auth
8360 stats enable
8361 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8362 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8363 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8364 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8365
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008366 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8367 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8368 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008369
8370
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8372 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008374 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008375 Arguments :
8376 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8377
8378 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8379
8380 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8381 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8382 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8383 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8384 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8385 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8386
8387 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8388 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8389 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008390 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008391
8392 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8393 report using "stats scope".
8394
8395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8397 unobvious parameters.
8398
8399 Example :
8400 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8401 backend public_www
8402 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8403 stats enable
8404 stats hide-version
8405 stats scope .
8406 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008407 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008408 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8409 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8410
8411 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8412 backend private_monitoring
8413 stats enable
8414 stats uri /admin?stats
8415 stats refresh 5s
8416
8417 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8418
8419
8420stats enable
8421 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008423 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008424 Arguments : none
8425
8426 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8427 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8428 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8429 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8430 - stats auth : no authentication
8431 - stats scope : no restriction
8432
8433 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8434 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8435 unobvious parameters.
8436
8437 Example :
8438 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8439 backend public_www
8440 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8441 stats enable
8442 stats hide-version
8443 stats scope .
8444 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008445 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008446 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8447 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8448
8449 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8450 backend private_monitoring
8451 stats enable
8452 stats uri /admin?stats
8453 stats refresh 5s
8454
8455 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8456
8457
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008458stats hide-version
8459 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008461 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008462 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008464 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8465 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8466 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8467 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8468 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8469 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008471 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8472 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8473 unobvious parameters.
8474
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008475 Example :
8476 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8477 backend public_www
8478 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008479 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008480 stats hide-version
8481 stats scope .
8482 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008483 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008484 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8485 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008486
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008487 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8488 backend private_monitoring
8489 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008490 stats uri /admin?stats
8491 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008492
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008493 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008494
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008495
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008496stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8498 Access control for statistics
8499
8500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8501 no | no | yes | yes
8502
8503 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8504 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8505 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8506 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8507 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8508 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8509
8510 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8511 instance.
8512
8513 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8514 about ACL usage.
8515
8516
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008517stats realm <realm>
8518 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008520 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008521 Arguments :
8522 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8523 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8524 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8525
8526 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8527 using a backslash ('\').
8528
8529 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8530 only related to authentication.
8531
8532 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8533 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8534 unobvious parameters.
8535
8536 Example :
8537 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8538 backend public_www
8539 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8540 stats enable
8541 stats hide-version
8542 stats scope .
8543 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008544 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008545 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8546 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8547
8548 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8549 backend private_monitoring
8550 stats enable
8551 stats uri /admin?stats
8552 stats refresh 5s
8553
8554 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8555
8556
8557stats refresh <delay>
8558 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008560 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008561 Arguments :
8562 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8563 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8564 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8565 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8566 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8567 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8568
8569 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8570 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8571 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8572 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8573
8574 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8575 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8576 unobvious parameters.
8577
8578 Example :
8579 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8580 backend public_www
8581 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8582 stats enable
8583 stats hide-version
8584 stats scope .
8585 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8588 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8589
8590 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8591 backend private_monitoring
8592 stats enable
8593 stats uri /admin?stats
8594 stats refresh 5s
8595
8596 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8597
8598
8599stats scope { <name> | "." }
8600 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008602 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008603 Arguments :
8604 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8605 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8606 section in which the statement appears.
8607
8608 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8609 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8610 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8611 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8612 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8613 exists.
8614
8615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8617 unobvious parameters.
8618
8619 Example :
8620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8621 backend public_www
8622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8623 stats enable
8624 stats hide-version
8625 stats scope .
8626 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008627 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8630
8631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8632 backend private_monitoring
8633 stats enable
8634 stats uri /admin?stats
8635 stats refresh 5s
8636
8637 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8638
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008639
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008640stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008641 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008645 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8647
8648 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8649 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8650
8651 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8652 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008653 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008654
8655 Example :
8656 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8657 backend private_monitoring
8658 stats enable
8659 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8660 stats uri /admin?stats
8661 stats refresh 5s
8662
8663 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8664 global section.
8665
8666
8667stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008668 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8670 yes | yes | yes | yes
8671 Arguments : none
8672
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008673 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008674 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8675 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8676 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8677 - IP (socket, server)
8678 - cookie (backend, server)
8679
8680 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8681 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008682 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008683
8684 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8685
8686
8687stats show-node [ <name> ]
8688 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691 Arguments:
8692 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8693 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8694
8695 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8696 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008697 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008698
8699 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8700 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8701 unobvious parameters.
8702
8703 Example:
8704 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8705 backend private_monitoring
8706 stats enable
8707 stats show-node Europe-1
8708 stats uri /admin?stats
8709 stats refresh 5s
8710
8711 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8712 section.
8713
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008714
8715stats uri <prefix>
8716 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719 Arguments :
8720 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8721 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8722 query string.
8723
8724 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8725 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8726 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8727 possible to reach it in the application.
8728
8729 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008730 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008731 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8732 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8733 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8734 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8735
8736 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8737 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8738 an address or a port to statistics only.
8739
8740 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8741 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8742 unobvious parameters.
8743
8744 Example :
8745 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8746 backend public_www
8747 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8748 stats enable
8749 stats hide-version
8750 stats scope .
8751 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008753 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8754 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8755
8756 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8757 backend private_monitoring
8758 stats enable
8759 stats uri /admin?stats
8760 stats refresh 5s
8761
8762 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8763
8764
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008765stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8766 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008768 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008769
8770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008771 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008772 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8775
8776 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8777 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8778 the "stick-table" statement.
8779
8780 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8781 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8782 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8783 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8784 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8785
8786 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8787 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8788 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8789 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8790 transformation rules.
8791
8792 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8793 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8794 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8795 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8796 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8797 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8798 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8799
8800 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8801 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8802 ACL based conditions.
8803
8804 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8805 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8806 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8807 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8808
8809 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8810 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8811 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8812 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8813
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008814 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8815 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008816 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008817
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008818 Example :
8819 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8820 # last 30 minutes
8821 backend pop
8822 mode tcp
8823 balance roundrobin
8824 stick store-request src
8825 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8826 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8827 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8828
8829 backend smtp
8830 mode tcp
8831 balance roundrobin
8832 stick match src table pop
8833 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8834 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8835
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008836 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008837 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008838
8839
8840stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8841 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 no | no | yes | yes
8844
8845 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8846 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8847 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8848 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008850 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8851 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008852 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008853
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008854 Examples :
8855 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008856 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008857
8858 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8859 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8860 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8861
8862
8863 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8864 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8865 backend http
8866 mode http
8867 balance roundrobin
8868 stick on src table https
8869 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8870 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8871 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8872
8873 backend https
8874 mode tcp
8875 balance roundrobin
8876 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8877 stick on src
8878 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8879 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8880
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008881 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008882
8883
8884stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8885 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8887 no | no | yes | yes
8888
8889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008890 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008891 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008892 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008893 server is selected.
8894
8895 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8896 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8897 the "stick-table" statement.
8898
8899 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8900 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8901 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8902 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8903 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8904 address.
8905
8906 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8907 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8908 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8909 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8910 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8911 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8912 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8913 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8914 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8915 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8916
8917 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8918 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8919 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8920 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8921 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8922 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8923 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8924
8925 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8926 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8927 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8928 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8929
8930 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8931 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8932 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8933 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8934 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8935 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008936 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8937 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8938 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8939 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8940 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8941 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008942
8943 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8944 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8945 the request.
8946
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008947 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8948 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008949 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008950
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008951 Example :
8952 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8953 # last 30 minutes
8954 backend pop
8955 mode tcp
8956 balance roundrobin
8957 stick store-request src
8958 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8959 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8960 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8961
8962 backend smtp
8963 mode tcp
8964 balance roundrobin
8965 stick match src table pop
8966 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8967 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8968
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008969 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008970 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008971
8972
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008973stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008974 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8975 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008976 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008978 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979
8980 Arguments :
8981 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8982 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8983 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8984 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8985
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008986 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8987 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8988 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8989 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8990
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008991 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8992 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8993 instance.
8994
8995 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8996 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8997 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8998 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8999 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9000 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009001 to 32 characters.
9002
9003 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9004 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9005 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009006 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009007 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9008 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009009
9010 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009011 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9012 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009013 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9014 increase.
9015
9016 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009017 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9018 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9019 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009020
9021 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9022 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9023 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9024 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009025 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009026 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9027 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9028 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9029 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9030 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9031 parameter (see below).
9032
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009033 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9034 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9035 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9036 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9037 soft restart.
9038
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009039 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9040 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009041
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009042 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9043 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9044 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9045 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009046 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009047 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009048 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9049 if not expiration delay is specified.
9050
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009051 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9052 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9053 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9054 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009055 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9056 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9057 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9058 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9059 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9060 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9061 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9062 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9063 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9064 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9065 types and their arguments.
9066
9067 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9068 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9069 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9070 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9071
9072 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9073 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9074 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009075 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009076
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009077 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9078 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9079 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009081 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009082 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009083
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009084 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9085 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9086 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9087 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9088
9089 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9090 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9091 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9092 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9093 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9094 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9095
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009096 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9097 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9098 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9099 they were received.
9100
9101 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9102 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9103 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9104 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9105 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9106
9107 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9108 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9109 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9110 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9111 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9112
9113 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9114 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9115 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9116
9117 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9118 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9119 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9120 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9121 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9122
9123 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9124 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9125 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9126 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9127 the client side.
9128
9129 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9130 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9131 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9132 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9133 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9134 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9135 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9136
9137 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9138 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9139 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9140 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9141 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9142 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009143 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009144
9145 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9146 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9147 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9148 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9149 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9150 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9151
9152 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009153 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009154 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9155 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9156
9157 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9158 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9159 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9160 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9161 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9162 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9163 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9164 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9165 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9166 recommended for better fairness.
9167
9168 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009169 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009170 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9171 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9172
9173 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9174 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9175 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9176 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9177 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9178 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9179 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9180 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9181 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9182 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009183
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009184 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9185 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009186 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9187 reference it.
9188
9189 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9190 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009191 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9192 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9193 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009194
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009195 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9196 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9197 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9198 something that can be ignored.
9199
9200 Example:
9201 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9202 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9203 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9204 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9205
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009206 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009207 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009208
9209
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009210stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009211 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9213 no | no | yes | yes
9214
9215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009216 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009217 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009218 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009219 server is selected.
9220
9221 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9222 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9223 the "stick-table" statement.
9224
9225 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9226 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9227 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9228 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9229
9230 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9231 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9232 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9233 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9234 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9235 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009236 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009237 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9238 rules.
9239
9240 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9241 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9242 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9243 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9244 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9245 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9246 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9247
9248 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9249 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9250 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9251 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9252
9253 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9254 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9255 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9256 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9257 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9258 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009259 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9260 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9261 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9262 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9263 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9264 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9265 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9266 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9267 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009268
9269 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9270
9271 Example :
9272 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9273 backend https
9274 mode tcp
9275 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009276 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009277 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009278
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009279 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9280 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9281
9282 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9283 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9284 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9285
9286 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9287 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009288
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009289 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9290 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9291 # at offset 44.
9292
9293 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9294 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9295
9296 # Learn on response if server hello.
9297 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009298
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009299 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9300 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9301
9302 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9303 extraction.
9304
9305
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009306tcp-check connect [params*]
9307 Opens a new connection
9308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9309 no | no | yes | yes
9310
9311 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9312 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9313 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9314
9315 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9316 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9317 of the sequence.
9318
9319 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9320 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9321 do.
9322
9323 Parameters :
9324 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9325 use the TCP connection.
9326
9327 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9328 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9329 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9330
9331 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9332
9333 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9334
9335 Examples:
9336 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9337 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9338 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9339 option tcp-check
9340 tcp-check connect
9341 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9342 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9343 tcp-check send \r\n
9344 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9345 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9346 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9347 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9348 tcp-check send \r\n
9349 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9350 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9351
9352 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9353 option tcp-check
9354 tcp-check connect port 110
9355 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9356 tcp-check connect port 143
9357 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9358 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9359
9360 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9361
9362
9363tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 no | no | yes | yes
9367
9368 Arguments :
9369 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9370 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9371 binary.
9372 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9373 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9374 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9375
9376 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9377 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9378 with the usual backslash ('\').
9379 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009380 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009381 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9382 used upper or lower case.
9383
9384
9385 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9386
9387 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9388 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9389 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9390 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9391 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9392 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9393 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9394 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9395
9396 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9397 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9398 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9399 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9400 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9401 expression.
9402
9403 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9404 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9405 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9406 this exact hexadecimal string.
9407 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9408
9409 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9410 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9411 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9412 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9413 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9414 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9415 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9416 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9417 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9418 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9419 the null character.
9420
9421 Examples :
9422 # perform a POP check
9423 option tcp-check
9424 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9425
9426 # perform an IMAP check
9427 option tcp-check
9428 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9429
9430 # look for the redis master server
9431 option tcp-check
9432 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009433 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009434 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9435 tcp-check expect string role:master
9436 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9437 tcp-check expect string +OK
9438
9439
9440 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9441 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9442
9443
9444tcp-check send <data>
9445 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 no | no | yes | yes
9448
9449 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9450 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9451
9452 Examples :
9453 # look for the redis master server
9454 option tcp-check
9455 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9456 tcp-check expect string role:master
9457
9458 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9459 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9460
9461
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009462tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9463 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009464 tcp health check
9465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9466 no | no | yes | yes
9467
9468 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9469 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009470 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009471 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9472 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9473 hexadecimal string.
9474 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9475
9476 Examples :
9477 # redis check in binary
9478 option tcp-check
9479 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9480 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9481
9482
9483 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9484 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9485
9486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9488 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9490 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009492 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9493 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009495 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009496
9497 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9498 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9500 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9501 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9502 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9503 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9504 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009505
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009506 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9507 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9508 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9509 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009510
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009511 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 - accept :
9513 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9514 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9515 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009517 - reject :
9518 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9519 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9520 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9521 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9522 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9523 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9524 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9525 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9526 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9527 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9528 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009529 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009530
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009531 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9532 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9533 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9534 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9535 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9536 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9537 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9538 hosts.
9539
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009540 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9541 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9542 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9543 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9544 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9545 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9546 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9547 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9548
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009549 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9550 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9551 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9552 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9553 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9554 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9555 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9556 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9557 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009558 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9559 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009560
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009561 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009562 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009563 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9564 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9565 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009566 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009567 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9568 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9569 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9570 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9571 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9572 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9573 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9574 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009575
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009576 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009577 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009579 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009580 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9581 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9582 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9585 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9586 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9587 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9590 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9591 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9592 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9593 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009594 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9595 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9596 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9597 layer7 information is extracted.
9598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009599 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9600 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9601 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9602 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9603 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009604
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009605 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9606 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9607 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9608 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9609
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009610 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9611 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9612 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9613 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9614
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009615 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9616 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9617 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9618 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9619 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009620
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009621 - set-src <expr> :
9622 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9623 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9624 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009625 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009627 Arguments:
9628 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9629 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009630
9631 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009632 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9633
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009634 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9635 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009636
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009637 - set-src-port <expr> :
9638 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9639 expression.
9640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009641 Arguments:
9642 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9643 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009644
9645 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009646 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9647
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009648 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9649 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9650 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009651
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009652 - set-dst <expr> :
9653 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9654 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9655 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9656 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9657 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9658
9659 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9660 followed by some converters.
9661
9662 Example:
9663
9664 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9665 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9666
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009667 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9668 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9669
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009670 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9671 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9672 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9673 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9674
9675
9676 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9677 followed by some converters.
9678
9679 Example:
9680
9681 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9682
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009683 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9684 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9685 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9686
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009687 - "silent-drop" :
9688 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009689 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009690 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9691 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9692 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9693 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9694 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009695 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9696 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009697 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9698 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009699 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009700 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9701 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9702 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9703 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9706 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9707 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9710 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9711 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009713 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009714 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009715 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009716
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009717 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9718 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9719 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009721 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009722 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9723 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009724
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009725 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9726
9727 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9728
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009729 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9730
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009731 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009732
9733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9735 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009737 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009738 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009739 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9740 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009745 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9746 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9747 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9748 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009749
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009750 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9751 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9752 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9753 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009754 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9755 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9756 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9757 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9758 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9759 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009760 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009761 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009762
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009763 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9764 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9765 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9766 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009768 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009769 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009770 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009771 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9772 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009773 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009774 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009775 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009776 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009777 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009778 - set-dst <expr>
9779 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009780 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009781 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009782 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009783 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009784 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009785
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009786 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9787 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009788 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9789 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009790
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009791 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9792 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9793 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9794 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9795 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9796 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009798 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009799 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9800 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009803 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9804 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9805 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9806 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009807 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9808 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9809 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009810
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009811 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009812 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9813 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9814 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009815
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009816 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9817 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9818
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009819 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009820 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9821 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009823 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9824 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009825 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009826 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9827 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009828 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009829 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009830 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009831 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9832 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009834 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9835 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009836
9837 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9838 followed by some converters.
9839
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009840 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9841 <var-name>.
9842
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009843 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9844 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9845 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9846 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9847 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9848
9849 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9850 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9851 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9852 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9853 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9854 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9855 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9856 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9857 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9858 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9859 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9860
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009861 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9862 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9863 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9864 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9865 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9866
9867 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9868
9869 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9870
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009871 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9872 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9873 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9874 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9875 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9876 evaluated.
9877
9878 Example:
9879 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9880
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009881 Example:
9882
9883 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009884 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009885
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009886 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9888 # and reject everything else.
9889 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9890 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009891 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 tcp-request content reject
9893
9894 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009895 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9896 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9897 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009898 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009899
9900 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9901 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9902 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009903 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009904 tcp-request content reject
9905
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009906 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009907 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009908 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009909 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009910 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9911 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009912
9913 Example:
9914 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9915 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009916 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009918 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009919 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920
9921 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009922 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 # protecting all our sites
9924 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009925 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9926 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009927 ...
9928 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9929
9930 backend http_dynamic
9931 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009932 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009933 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009934 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009935 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009936 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009937 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009939 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009940
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009941 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9942 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009943
9944
9945tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9946 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009948 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009949 Arguments :
9950 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9951 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9952 as explained at the top of this document.
9953
9954 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9955 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9956 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9957 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9958 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9959
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009960 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9961 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9962 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9963 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9964
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009965 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9966 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009967 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009968 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009969 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9970 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9971 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9972 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009973
9974 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9975 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9976 it pass through unaffected.
9977
9978 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9979 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9980 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009981 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009982 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9983 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009984 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9985 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9986 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009987
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009988 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009989 "timeout client".
9990
9991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009992tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9993 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 no | no | yes | yes
9996 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009997 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9998 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009999
10000 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010002 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010003 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10004 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010005 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10006 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010007
10008 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10009
10010 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10011 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10012 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10013 inserted.
10014
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010015 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010016 - accept :
10017 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10018 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10019 the rules evaluation.
10020
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010021 - close :
10022 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10023 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10024 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10025 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10026 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10027 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010028 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010029 protocols.
10030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010031 - reject :
10032 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10033 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010034 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010035
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010036 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10037 Sets a variable.
10038
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010039 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10040 Unsets a variable.
10041
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010042 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10043 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10044 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10045 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010047 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10048 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10049 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10050 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10051
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010052 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10053 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10054 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10055 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10056 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010057
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010058 - "silent-drop" :
10059 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010060 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010061 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10062 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10063 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10064 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10065 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010066 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10067 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010068 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10069 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010070 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010071 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10072 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10073 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10074 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10075
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010076 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10077 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10078
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010079 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10080 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10081 for changing the default action to a reject.
10082
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010083 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10084 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10085 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10086 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010087 period.
10088
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010089 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10090 declared inline.
10091
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010092 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10093 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010097 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010099 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010100 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10101 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010102 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010103 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10104 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010105
10106 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10107 followed by some converters.
10108
10109 Example:
10110
10111 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10112
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010113 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10114 <var-name>.
10115
10116 Example:
10117
10118 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10119
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010120 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10121 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10122 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10123 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10124 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10125
10126 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10127
10128 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10129
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010130 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10131
10132 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10133
10134
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010135tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10136 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10138 no | yes | yes | no
10139 Arguments :
10140 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10141 below.
10142
10143 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10144
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010145 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010146 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10147 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10148 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10149 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10150 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10151 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10152 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010153 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010154 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10155 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10156 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10157 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10158 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10159 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10160 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10161 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10162 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10163 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10164 instead.
10165
10166 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10167 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10168 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10169 rules which may be inserted.
10170
10171 Several types of actions are supported :
10172 - accept : the request is accepted
10173 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10174 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10175 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010176 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010177 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010178 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010179 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010180 - silent-drop
10181
10182 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10183 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10184 sections for a complete description.
10185
10186 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10187 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10188 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10189
10190 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10191 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10192 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10193 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10194 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10195
10196 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10197 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10198
10199 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10200 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10201 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10202
10203 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10204 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10205 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10206
10207 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10208 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10209 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10210
10211 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10212 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10213 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10214
10215 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10216
10217 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10218
10219
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010220tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10221 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10223 no | no | yes | yes
10224 Arguments :
10225 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10226 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10227 as explained at the top of this document.
10228
10229 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10230
10231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010232timeout check <timeout>
10233 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10234 established.
10235
10236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10237 yes | no | yes | yes
10238 Arguments:
10239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10241 as explained at the top of this document.
10242
10243 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10244 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010245 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010246 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010247 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10248 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10249 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010250
10251 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10252 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10253
10254 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10255 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010256 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010257
10258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10260 forget about it.
10261
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010262 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10263 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010264
10265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010266timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010267 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10269 yes | yes | yes | no
10270 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10273 as explained at the top of this document.
10274
10275 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10276 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10277 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010278 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10279 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10280 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10281 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010282 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10283 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10284 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010285 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010286 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010287 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10288 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010289 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10290 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010291
10292 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10293 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10294 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10295 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010296 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010297 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10298
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010299 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010300
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010301 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010303
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010304timeout client-fin <timeout>
10305 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10307 yes | yes | yes | no
10308 Arguments :
10309 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10310 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10311 as explained at the top of this document.
10312
10313 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10314 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10315 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10316 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10317 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10318 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10319 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010320 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10321 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10322 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010323
10324 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10325 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10326 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10327
10328 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10329
10330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010331timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010332 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 yes | no | yes | yes
10335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010336 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010337 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10338 as explained at the top of this document.
10339
10340 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010341 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010342 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010343 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010344 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10345 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010346
10347 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10348 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10349 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10350 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010351 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010352 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10353
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010354 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010356
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010357timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10358 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10360 yes | yes | yes | yes
10361 Arguments :
10362 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10363 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10364 as explained at the top of this document.
10365
10366 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10367 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10368 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10369 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10370 once the request has started to present itself.
10371
10372 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10373 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10374 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10375 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10376 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10377
10378 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10379 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10380 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10381 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10382
10383 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10384 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010385 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010386 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10387 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010388 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010389
10390 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10391 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10392 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10393 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10394
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010395 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10396 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010397 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10398
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010399 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10400
10401
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010402timeout http-request <timeout>
10403 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010407 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010408 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10409 as explained at the top of this document.
10410
10411 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10412 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10413 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10414 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10415 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10416 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10417 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010418 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10419 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10420 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10421 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010422 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010423 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10424 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010425
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010426 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10427 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10428 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10429 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10430 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010431 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010432
10433 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10434 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010435 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010436 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10437 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10438
10439 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010440 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10441 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10442 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010443
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010444 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010445 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010446
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010447
10448timeout queue <timeout>
10449 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10451 yes | no | yes | yes
10452 Arguments :
10453 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10454 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10455 as explained at the top of this document.
10456
10457 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10458 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10459 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10460 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10461 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10462
10463 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10464 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10465 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10466 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10467
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010468 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010469
10470
10471timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010472 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10474 yes | no | yes | yes
10475 Arguments :
10476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10478 as explained at the top of this document.
10479
10480 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10481 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10482 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10483 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10484 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10485 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10486 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10487
10488 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10489 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10490 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10491 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10492 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010493 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010494 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010495 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10496 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010497 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10498 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010499
10500 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10501 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10502 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10503 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010504 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010505 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10506
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010507 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010508
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010509
10510timeout server-fin <timeout>
10511 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 yes | no | yes | yes
10514 Arguments :
10515 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10516 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10517 as explained at the top of this document.
10518
10519 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10520 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10521 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10522 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10523 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10524 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10525 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10526 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10527 situations, it should not be needed.
10528
10529 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10530 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10531 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10532
10533 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10534
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535
10536timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010537 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10539 yes | yes | yes | yes
10540 Arguments :
10541 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10543 as explained at the top of this document.
10544
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010545 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10546 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10547 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010548
10549 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10550 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10551 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10552 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010553 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010554
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010555 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010556
10557
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010558timeout tunnel <timeout>
10559 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10561 yes | no | yes | yes
10562 Arguments :
10563 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10565 as explained at the top of this document.
10566
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010567 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010568 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10569 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10570 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010571 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10572 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010573 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10574 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10575 specified.
10576
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010577 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10578 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10579 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10580 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10581 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10582 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10583 state.
10584
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010585 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10586 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10587 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10588 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010590
10591 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10592 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10593 forget about it.
10594
10595 Example :
10596 defaults http
10597 option http-server-close
10598 timeout connect 5s
10599 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010600 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010601 timeout server 30s
10602 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10603
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010604 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010605
10606
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010607transparent (deprecated)
10608 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010610 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010611 Arguments : none
10612
10613 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10614 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10615 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10616 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10617 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10618 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10619 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10620 appropriate server.
10621
10622 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10623
10624 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10625 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10626
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010627 See also: "option transparent"
10628
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010629unique-id-format <string>
10630 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10632 yes | yes | yes | no
10633 Arguments :
10634 <string> is a log-format string.
10635
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010636 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10637 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10638 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10639 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010640
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010641 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10642 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10643 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10644 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10645 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10646 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10647 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10648 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010649
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010650 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10651 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010652
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010653 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010654
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010655 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010656
10657 will generate:
10658
10659 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10660
10661 See also: "unique-id-header"
10662
10663unique-id-header <name>
10664 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10666 yes | yes | yes | no
10667 Arguments :
10668 <name> is the name of the header.
10669
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010670 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10671 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010673 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010674
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010675 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010676 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10677
10678 will generate:
10679
10680 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10681
10682 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010683
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010684use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010685 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10687 no | yes | yes | no
10688 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010689 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10690 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010691
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010692 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10693 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010694
10695 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10696 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10697 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010698 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010699 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010700 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10701 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010702
10703 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10704 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10705 assign the backend.
10706
10707 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10708 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10709 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10710 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10711 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10712 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10713
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010714 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010715 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010716 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10717 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10718 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10719
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010720 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10721 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10722 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10723 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10724 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10725 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10726 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10727 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10728 cannot be forced from the request.
10729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010730 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010731 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10732 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10733
10734 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10735 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010736
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010737use-fcgi-app <name>
10738 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10740 no | no | yes | yes
10741 Arguments :
10742 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10743
10744 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010745
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010746use-server <server> if <condition>
10747use-server <server> unless <condition>
10748 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10750 no | no | yes | yes
10751 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010752 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010753
10754 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10755
10756 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10757 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10758 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10759
10760 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10761 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10762 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10763 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10764 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10765 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10766 matches will assign the server.
10767
10768 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10769 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10770 with the next rules until one matches.
10771
10772 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10773 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10774 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10775 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10776
10777 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10778 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10779 stripped.
10780
10781 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10782 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10783 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10784 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10785
10786 Example :
10787 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10788 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10789 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10790 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10791 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10792 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010793 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010794 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10795 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10796
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010797 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108005. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010801--------------------------
10802
10803The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10804depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10805settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10806written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10807described in this section.
10808
10809
108105.1. Bind options
10811-----------------
10812
10813The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10814as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10815no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10816parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10817while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10818provided immediately after the setting name.
10819
10820The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10821
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010822accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10823 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10824 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10825 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10826 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10827 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10828 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10829 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10830 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10831 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010832 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10833 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10834 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010835
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010836accept-proxy
10837 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010838 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10839 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010840 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10841 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10842 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10843 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10846 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010847 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10848 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010849
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010850allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010851 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010852 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010853 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010854 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10855 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010856
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010857alpn <protocols>
10858 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10859 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10860 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010861 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010862 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010863 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10864 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10865 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10866 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10867 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10868 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10869 preference, like below :
10870
10871 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010872
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010873backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010874 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010875 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10876
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010877curves <curves>
10878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10879 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10880 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10881 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10882 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10883 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10884
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010885ecdhe <named curve>
10886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010887 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10888 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010889
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010890ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10892 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10893 client's certificate.
10894
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010895ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10897 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10898 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10899 error is ignored.
10900
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010901ca-sign-file <cafile>
10902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10903 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10904 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10905 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10906 'generate-certificates' for details.
10907
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010908ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10910 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10911 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10912 'generate-certificates' for details.
10913
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010914ciphers <ciphers>
10915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10916 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010917 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010918 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010919 information and recommendations see e.g.
10920 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10921 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10922 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10923
10924ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10926 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10927 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10928 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010929 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10930 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010931
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010932crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10934 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10935 to verify client's certificate.
10936
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010937crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10939 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10940 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10941 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10942 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10943 file.
10944
10945 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10946 are loaded.
10947
10948 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010949 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010950 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10951 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10952 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10953 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10955 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010956 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010957
10958 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10959 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10960 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10961 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010962 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10963 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010964
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010965 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010966
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010967 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010968 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010969 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10970 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010971 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10972 clients).
10973
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010974 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10975 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10976 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10977 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10978 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10979 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10980 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10981 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10982 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10983 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10984 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10985 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10986 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10987
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010988 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10989 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10990 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10991 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10992 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10993
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010994 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10995 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10996 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10997 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010998
10999 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11000 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11001 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11002 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11003 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11004 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11005 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11006 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11007 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11008
11009 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11010
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011011 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011012 a cert bundle.
11013
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011014 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011015 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11016 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11017 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11018 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11019 provide multi-cert support.
11020
11021 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11022
11023 Filename | CN | SAN
11024 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11025 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011026 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011027 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11028 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11029
11030 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11031 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11032 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11033 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011034 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11035 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11036 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011037
11038 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11039 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11040
11041 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11042 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11043 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11044
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011045crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011047 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011048 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011049 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011050
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011051crt-list <file>
11052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011053 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11054 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011055
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011056 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11057
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011058 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11059 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011060 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011061 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011062
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011063 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11064 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11065 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11066 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11067 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11068 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11069 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11070 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011071
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011072 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011073 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011074 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11075 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11076 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011077
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011078 crt-list file example:
11079 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011080 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011081 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011082 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011084defer-accept
11085 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11086 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11087 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011089 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11090 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11091 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11092 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11093 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11094 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11095 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11096
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011097expose-fd listeners
11098 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11099 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011100 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11101 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011102 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011103
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011104force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011105 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011106 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011107 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011109
11110force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011112 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011114
11115force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011116 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011117 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011118 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011119
11120force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011121 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011122 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011124
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011125force-tlsv13
11126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11127 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011128 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011129
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011130generate-certificates
11131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11132 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11133 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11134 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11135 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11136 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11137 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11138 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11139 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11140 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11141 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11142
11143 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11144 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011145 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011146 certificate is used many times.
11147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148gid <gid>
11149 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11150 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11151 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11152 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11153 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11154
11155group <group>
11156 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11157 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11158 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11159 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11160 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11161
11162id <id>
11163 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11164 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11165 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11166 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11167
11168interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011169 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11170 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11171 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11172 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11173 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11174 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011175 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11176 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11177 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11178 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11179 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11180 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011181
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011182level <level>
11183 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11184 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11185 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011186 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011187 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11188 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11189 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011190 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011191 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011192 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011193 all counters).
11194
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011195severity-output <format>
11196 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11197 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11198 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11199 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11200 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11201 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11202 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11203 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11204 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11205 rfc5424 convention.
11206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011207maxconn <maxconn>
11208 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11209 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11210 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11211 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11212 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11213 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11214 eat all memory.
11215
11216mode <mode>
11217 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11218 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11219 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11220 UNIX sockets.
11221
11222mss <maxseg>
11223 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11224 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11225 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11226 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11227 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11228 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11229 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11230 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11231 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11232 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11233 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11234
11235name <name>
11236 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11237 page.
11238
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011239namespace <name>
11240 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11241 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11242 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11243 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11244
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011245nice <nice>
11246 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11247 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11248 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11249 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11250 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11251 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11252 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11253 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11254 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11255 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11256 one for an RDP socket.
11257
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011258no-ca-names
11259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11260 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11261
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011262no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011264 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011265 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011266 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011267 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11268 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011270no-tls-tickets
11271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11272 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11273 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011274 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11275 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011276
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011277no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011279 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011280 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011281 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011282 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11283 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011284
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011285no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011287 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011288 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011289 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011290 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11291 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011292
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011293no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011295 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011296 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011297 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011298 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11299 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011300
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011301no-tlsv13
11302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11303 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11304 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11305 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011306 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11307 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011308
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011309npn <protocols>
11310 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11311 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11312 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011313 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011314 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011315 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11316 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11317 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11318 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11319 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011320
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011321prefer-client-ciphers
11322 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11323 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11324 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011325 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11326 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11327 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011328
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011329process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011330 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011331 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011332 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011333 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11334 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11335 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11336 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011337 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011338 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11339 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11340 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11341 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11342 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011343
11344 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11345
11346 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11347 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11348 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11349 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11350 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11351 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11352 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11353 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011354
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011355proto <name>
11356 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11357 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11358 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11359 in haproxy -vv.
11360 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11361 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011362 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011363 h2" on the bind line.
11364
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011365ssl
11366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011367 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011368 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11369 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011370 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11371 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011372
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011373ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11374 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11375 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11376 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11377
11378ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11379 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11380 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11381 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11382
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011383strict-sni
11384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11385 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11386 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11387 See the "crt" option for more information.
11388
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011389tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011390 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011391 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11392 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011393 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011394 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11395 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11396 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11397 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11398 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11399 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11400 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11401
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011402tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011403 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011404 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11405 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11406 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11407 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11408 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11409 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11410 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011411 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11412 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11413 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011414
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011415tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11416 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011417 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11418 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11419 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11420 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11421 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11422 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11423 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11424 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11425 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11426 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011427 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11428 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011430transparent
11431 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11432 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11433 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11434 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11435 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11436 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11437 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11438 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11439 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11440 so check for support with your vendor.
11441
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011442v4v6
11443 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11444 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11445 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11446 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011447 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011448
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011449v6only
11450 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11451 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11452 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011453 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11454 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011455
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011456uid <uid>
11457 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11458 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11459 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11460 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11461 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11462
11463user <user>
11464 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11465 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11466 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11467 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11468 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11469
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011470verify [none|optional|required]
11471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11472 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11473 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11474 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11475 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011476 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11477 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11478 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11479 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114815.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011482------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011484The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11485which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11486arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11487settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11488after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11489Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11490address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011492 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011493 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011494
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011495Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11496keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011498The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011499
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011500addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011501 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011502 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11503 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11504 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11505 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11506 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011507
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011508agent-check
11509 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011510 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011511 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11512 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11513 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011514
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011515 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011516 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011517 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11518 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11519 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011520
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011521 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11522 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11523 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11524 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11525 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011526
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011527 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011529
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011530 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11531 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11532 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011533
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011534 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11535 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11536 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011537
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011538 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11539 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11540 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11541 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11542 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011544 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011545
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011546 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11547 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011548
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011549 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11550 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11551 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11552 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11553 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11554 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11555 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11556 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11557 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011558
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011559 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11560 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011561 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11562 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11563 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011564 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011565
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011566 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011567 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011568
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011569agent-send <string>
11570 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11571 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11572 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11573 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11574 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11575
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011576agent-inter <delay>
11577 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11578 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11579
11580 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11581 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11582 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11583 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11584 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11585 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11586 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11587 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11588 of backends use the same servers.
11589
11590 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11591
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011592agent-addr <addr>
11593 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11594
11595 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11596 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11597 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11598 hostname, it will be resolved.
11599
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011600agent-port <port>
11601 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11602
11603 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11604
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011605allow-0rtt
11606 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011607 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11608 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011609
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011610alpn <protocols>
11611 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11612 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11613 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011614 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011615 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11616 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11617 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11618 now obsolete NPN extension.
11619 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11620 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11621
11622 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624backup
11625 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11626 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11627 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11628 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011629 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11630 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011631
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011632ca-file <cafile>
11633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11634 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11635 server's certificate.
11636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011637check
11638 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011639 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11640 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11641 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11642 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11643 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11644 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11645 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011646 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11647 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011648 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11649 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011650
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011651check-send-proxy
11652 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11653 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11654 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11655 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11656 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11657 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11658 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11659
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011660check-alpn <protocols>
11661 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11662 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11663 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11664
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011665check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011666 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011667 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11668 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011669
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011670check-ssl
11671 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11672 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11673 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11674 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011675 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011676 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11677 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011678 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011679 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11680 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011681
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011682check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011683 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011684 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11685 for normal traffic.
11686
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011687ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11689 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11690 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011691 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11692 information and recommendations see e.g.
11693 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11694 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11695 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011696
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011697ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11699 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11700 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11701 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011702 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11703 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11704 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011706cookie <value>
11707 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11708 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11709 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11710 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11711 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11712 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11713 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11714
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011715crl-file <crlfile>
11716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11717 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11718 to verify server's certificate.
11719
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011720crt <cert>
11721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11722 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11723 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11724 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11725 certificate request.
11726
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011727disabled
11728 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11729 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11730 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11731 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11732 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011733 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011734
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011735enabled
11736 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11737 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11738 default value.
11739 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11740 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011742error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011743 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11744 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11745 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011747 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011749fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011750 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11751 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11752 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11753
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011754force-sslv3
11755 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11756 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011757 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011758 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011759
11760force-tlsv10
11761 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011762 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011764
11765force-tlsv11
11766 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011767 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011769
11770force-tlsv12
11771 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011772 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011773 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011774
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011775force-tlsv13
11776 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11777 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011778 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011780id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011781 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11782 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11783 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011785init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11786 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11787 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011788 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011789 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11790 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11791 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11792 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11793 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11794 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11795 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11796 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11797 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011799 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11800 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11801 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11802 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11803 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11804 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011805 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011806
11807 Example:
11808 defaults
11809 # never fail on address resolution
11810 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011812inter <delay>
11813fastinter <delay>
11814downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011815 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11816 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11817 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11818 between checks depending on the server state :
11819
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011820 Server state | Interval used
11821 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11822 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11823 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11824 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11825 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11826 or yet unchecked. |
11827 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11828 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11829 | "inter" otherwise.
11830 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011832 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11833 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11834 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11835 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011836 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11837 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11838 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11839 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11840 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011842maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011843 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11844 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011845 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11846 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011847 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11848 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11849 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11850 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11851
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011852 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11853 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11854 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11855 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11856 than 50 concurrent requests.
11857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011858maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011859 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11860 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11861 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11862 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11863 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11864 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11865 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11866
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011867max-reuse <count>
11868 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11869 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11870 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11871 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11872 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11873 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11874 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11875 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011877minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11879 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11880 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11881 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11882 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11883 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011884 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011886
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011887namespace <name>
11888 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11889 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11890 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11891 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11892
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011893no-agent-check
11894 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11895 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11896 default value.
11897 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11898 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11899
11900no-backup
11901 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11902 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11903 default value.
11904 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11905 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11906
11907no-check
11908 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11909 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11910 default value.
11911 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11912 "default-server" "check" setting.
11913
11914no-check-ssl
11915 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11916 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11917 default value.
11918 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11919 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11920
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011921no-send-proxy
11922 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11923 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11924 default value.
11925 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11926 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11927
11928no-send-proxy-v2
11929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11931 default value.
11932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11933 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11934
11935no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11936 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11937 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11938 default value.
11939 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11940 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11941
11942no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11943 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11944 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11945 default value.
11946 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11947 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11948
11949no-ssl
11950 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11951 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11952 default value.
11953 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11954 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11955
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011956no-ssl-reuse
11957 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11958 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11959 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11960 and for paranoid users.
11961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011962no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011963 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11964 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011965 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011966
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011967 Supported in default-server: No
11968
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011969no-tls-tickets
11970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11971 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11972 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011973 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11974 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011975 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011976
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011977no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011978 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011979 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11980 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011981 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11982 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011983 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011984
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011985 Supported in default-server: No
11986
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011987no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011988 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011989 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11990 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011991 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11992 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011993 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011994
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011995 Supported in default-server: No
11996
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011997no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011998 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011999 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12000 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012001 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12002 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012003 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012004
12005 Supported in default-server: No
12006
12007no-tlsv13
12008 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12009 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12010 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12011 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12012 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012013 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012014
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012015 Supported in default-server: No
12016
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012017no-verifyhost
12018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12020 default value.
12021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12022 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012023
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012024no-tfo
12025 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12026 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12027 default value.
12028 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12029 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12030
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012031non-stick
12032 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12033 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12034 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12035
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012036npn <protocols>
12037 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12038 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12039 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012040 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012041 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12042 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12043 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012045observe <mode>
12046 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12047 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12048 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12049 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12050 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12051 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012052 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012053
12054 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012056on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012057 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12058 Currently, four modes are available:
12059 - fastinter: force fastinter
12060 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12061 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12062 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12063 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12064
12065 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12066
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012067on-marked-down <action>
12068 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12069 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012070 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12071 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12072 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12073 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12074 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12075 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12076 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12077 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012078
12079 Actions are disabled by default
12080
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012081on-marked-up <action>
12082 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12083 Currently one action is available:
12084 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12085 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12086 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12087 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012088 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12089 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012090 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12091 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12092
12093 Actions are disabled by default
12094
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012095pool-max-conn <max>
12096 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12097 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12098 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12099 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12100 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12101 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12102
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012103pool-purge-delay <delay>
12104 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012105 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012106 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012108port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12110 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12111 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12112 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12113 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12114 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12115
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012116proto <name>
12117
12118 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12119 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12120 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12121 reported in haproxy -vv.
12122 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12123 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012125redir <prefix>
12126 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12127 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12128 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12129 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12130 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12131 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12132 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12133 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012134 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012135 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012136 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12137 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12138 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12139 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12140
12141 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012143rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012144 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12145 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12146 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12147
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012148resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12149 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12150 server.
12151
12152 Available options:
12153
12154 * allow-dup-ip
12155 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12156 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12157 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12158 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12159 For such case, simply enable this option.
12160 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12161
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012162 * ignore-weight
12163 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12164 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12165 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12166
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012167 * prevent-dup-ip
12168 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12169 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12170 same fqdn.
12171 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12172
12173 Example:
12174 backend b_myapp
12175 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12176 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12177 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12178
12179 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12180 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12181 it
12182 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12183 different address
12184
12185 Default value: not set
12186
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012187resolve-prefer <family>
12188 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12189 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12190 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12191 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12192
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012193 Default value: ipv6
12194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012195 Example:
12196
12197 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012198
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012199resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012200 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012201 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012202 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012203 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12204 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012205 configured network, another address is selected.
12206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012207 Example:
12208
12209 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012210
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012211resolvers <id>
12212 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12213 hostname.
12214
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012215 Example:
12216
12217 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012218
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012219 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012220
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012221send-proxy
12222 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12223 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12224 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12225 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012226 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12227 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12228 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12229 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12230 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12231 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12232 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12233 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12234 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12235 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012236 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12237 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012238
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012239send-proxy-v2
12240 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12241 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12242 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12243 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012244 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12245 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12246 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12247 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012248
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012249proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12250 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12251 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012252 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12253 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012254 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12255 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012256 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012257
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012258send-proxy-v2-ssl
12259 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12260 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12261 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12262 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12263 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12264 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12265 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012266 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12267 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012268
12269send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12270 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12271 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12272 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12273 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12274 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12275 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12276 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12277 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012278 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12279 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012281slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012282 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12283 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12284 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12285 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12286 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12287 parameters :
12288
12289 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12290 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12291
12292 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12293 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12294 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12295 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12296
12297 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12298 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12299 seen as failed.
12300
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012301sni <expression>
12302 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12303 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12304 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12305 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012306 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12307 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012308 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012309 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12310 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012311
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012312source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012313source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012314source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012315 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12316 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12317 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12318 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12319
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012320 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12321 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12322 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12323 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12324 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12325 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12326 server.
12327
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012328 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12329 specifying the source address without port(s).
12330
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012331ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012332 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12333 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12334 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12335 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12336 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12337 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012338 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12339 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012340
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012341ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12342 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12343 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12344 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12345
12346ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12347 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12348 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12349 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12350
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012351ssl-reuse
12352 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12353 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12354 default value.
12355 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12356 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12357
12358stick
12359 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12360 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12361 default value.
12362 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12363 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012364
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012365socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012366 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012367 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12368 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12369
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012370tcp-ut <delay>
12371 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12372 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12373 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012374 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012375 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12376 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12377 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12378 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12379 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12380 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12381 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12382 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12383 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12384
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012385tfo
12386 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12387 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12388 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12389 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12390 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012391 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012393track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012394 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12395 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12396 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12397 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012398 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12399
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012400tls-tickets
12401 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12402 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12403 default value.
12404 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12405 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012406
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012407verify [none|required]
12408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012409 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012410 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12411 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012412 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012413 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12414 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12415 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12416 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12417 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12418 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12419 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12420 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012421
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012422verifyhost <hostname>
12423 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012424 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12425 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12426 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12427 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12428 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12429 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12430 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12431 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012433weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012434 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12435 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12436 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012437 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12438 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12439 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12440 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12441 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12442 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012443
12444
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124455.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12446-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012447
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012448HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12449using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12450configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012451This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12452can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12453workload.
12454This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12455resolution at run time.
12456Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12457carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12458
12459
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124605.3.1. Global overview
12461----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012462
12463As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12464different steps of the process life:
12465
12466 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12467 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12468 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12469
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012470 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12471 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012472
12473A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12474 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12475 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12476 resolution to know this new IP.
12477
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012478When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012479HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012480SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12481from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12482will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12483will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012484
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012485A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012486 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012487 first valid response.
12488
12489 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12490 servers return an error.
12491
12492
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124935.3.2. The resolvers section
12494----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012495
12496This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012497HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12498contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012499
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012500When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12501uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12502is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12503answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12504
12505When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012506used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012507
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012508 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12509 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12510 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012511
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012512 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12513 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012514
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012515 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12516 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12517 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012518
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012519For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12520following scenarios are possible:
12521
12522 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12523 ignored
12524
12525 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12526 applied
12527
12528 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12529 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12530
12531 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12532 retries the query with a new type
12533
12534 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12535 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012536
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012537As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12538a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012539<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012540
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012541
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012542resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012543 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544
12545A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12546
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012547accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012548 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012549 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012550 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12551 by RFC 6891)
12552
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012553 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12554
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012555nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12556 DNS server description:
12557 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12558 <ip> : IP address of the server
12559 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12560
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012561parse-resolv-conf
12562 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12563 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12564 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12565
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012566hold <status> <period>
12567 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12568 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012569 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012570 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012571 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12572 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12573 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12574
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012575 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012577resolve_retries <nb>
12578 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12579 giving up.
12580 Default value: 3
12581
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012582 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12583 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12584 type.
12585
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012586timeout <event> <time>
12587 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12588 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12589 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012590 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12591 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012592 Default value: 1s
12593 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012594 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012595 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012596 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12597 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12598
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012599 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012600
12601 resolvers mydns
12602 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12603 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012604 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012605 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012606 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012607 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012608 hold other 30s
12609 hold refused 30s
12610 hold nx 30s
12611 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012612 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012613 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012614
12615
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200126166. Cache
12617---------
12618
12619HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12620(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12621RAM.
12622
12623The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12624this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12625
12626If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12627independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12628when we try to allocate a new one.
12629
12630The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12631
12632It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12633"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12634for more details.
12635
12636When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12637replaced by "<CACHE>".
12638
12639
126406.1. Limitation
12641----------------
12642
12643The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12644
12645- If the response is not a 200
12646- If the response contains a Vary header
12647- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12648- If the response is not cacheable
12649
12650- If the request is not a GET
12651- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12652- If the request contains an Authorization header
12653
12654
126556.2. Setup
12656-----------
12657
12658To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12659the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12660
12661
126626.2.1. Cache section
12663---------------------
12664
12665cache <name>
12666 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12667 size of cache is mandatory.
12668
12669total-max-size <megabytes>
12670 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12671 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12672
12673max-object-size <bytes>
12674 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12675 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12676 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12677
12678max-age <seconds>
12679 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12680 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12681 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12682 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12683 default.
12684
12685
126866.2.2. Proxy section
12687---------------------
12688
12689http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12690 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12691 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12692 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12693 after this one.
12694
12695http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12696 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12697 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12698 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12699 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12700
12701
12702Example:
12703
12704 backend bck1
12705 mode http
12706
12707 http-request cache-use foobar
12708 http-response cache-store foobar
12709 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12710
12711 cache foobar
12712 total-max-size 4
12713 max-age 240
12714
12715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127167. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12717----------------------------------
12718
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012719HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12721The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12722these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12723but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12724data called patterns.
12725
12726
127277.1. ACL basics
12728---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012729
12730The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12731content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12732from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12733simple :
12734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012736 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12738 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012740The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12741adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012742
12743In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012746
12747This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12748Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12749and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012750an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12751conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12752as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12753are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012754
12755ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12756'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12757which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12758
12759There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12760performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12763specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12764this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012765methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12766ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767
12768Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12769 - boolean
12770 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12771 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12772 - string
12773 - data block
12774
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012775Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12776converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12777would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12778The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12779which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12780
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012781Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12782keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12783fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12784which are summarized in the table below :
12785
12786 +---------------------+-----------------+
12787 | Sample or converter | Default |
12788 | output type | matching method |
12789 +---------------------+-----------------+
12790 | boolean | bool |
12791 +---------------------+-----------------+
12792 | integer | int |
12793 +---------------------+-----------------+
12794 | ip | ip |
12795 +---------------------+-----------------+
12796 | string | str |
12797 +---------------------+-----------------+
12798 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12799 +---------------------+-----------------+
12800
12801Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12802matching method, see below.
12803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12805 - boolean
12806 - integer or integer range
12807 - IP address / network
12808 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12809 - regular expression
12810 - hex block
12811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012812The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12813
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012814 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12815 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012816 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012817 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012818 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012819 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012820 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12823read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12824if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12825lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12826will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12827beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12828a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12829lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12830exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12831
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012832The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12833parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12834ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12835a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12836check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12837
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012838The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12839socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12840file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012842Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12843loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12844
12845 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12846
12847In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12848the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12849case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12850as well.
12851
12852The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12853sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12854do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12855methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12856is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012857obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12859default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12860that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12861string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12862
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012863The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12864By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12865string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12866resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12867server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012868waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012869flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12870function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12873sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12874be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012875
12876 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12877 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12879 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12880 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12881 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012882
12883 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12884 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012886
12887 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012889
12890 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012892
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012893 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012894 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12895
12896 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12897 binary or string samples.
12898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12900 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12903 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12904 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12907 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12910 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12913 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12916 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012917 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12920 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12921 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012922
12923For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12924request, it is possible to do :
12925
12926 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12927
12928In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12929buffer, one would use the following acl :
12930
12931 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12932
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012933On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12934possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12935
12936 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012938All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12939criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12940method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12941to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12942criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12943the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012946the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12947For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12950 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12951 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12952 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012953
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012954
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012955The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12956types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12957combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12958brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12959default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012961 +-------------------------------------------------+
12962 | Input sample type |
12963 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012964 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12966 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12967 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012968 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012970 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012972 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012973 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012974 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012976 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012977 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012978 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012980 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012982 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012983 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012984 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012986 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012988 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12990 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12991 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012992
12993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129947.1.1. Matching booleans
12995------------------------
12996
12997In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12998Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12999When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13000that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13001
13002Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13003return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13004"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130077.1.2. Matching integers
13008------------------------
13009
13010Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13011enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13012to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13013
13014Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13015matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13016lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013017
13018For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13019unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13020representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13021
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013022As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13023two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13024instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13025ranges and operators.
13026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013027For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013028operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13029Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13030of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013032Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013033
13034 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13035 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13036 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13037 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13038 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013040For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013041
13042 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13043
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013044This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13045
13046 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130497.1.3. Matching strings
13050-----------------------
13051
13052String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13053different forms :
13054
13055 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013056 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057
13058 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013059 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060
13061 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13062 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13063
13064 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13065 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13066
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013067 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13069 matches.
13070
13071 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13072 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13073 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013074
13075String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13076exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13077characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13078string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13079to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013080before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013081
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013082Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13083(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13084Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13085
13086Example:
13087 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13088 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13089
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130917.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13092---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013093
13094Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13095they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13096possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13097passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13098the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013099the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13100match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013101
13102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131037.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13104-------------------------------------
13105
13106It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13107not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13108a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13109to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13110digits may be used upper or lower case.
13111
13112Example :
13113 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13114 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13115
13116
131177.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13118---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013119
13120IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13121netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13122within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013123host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013124difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13125at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13126does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13127parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013128
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013129The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13130abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13131
13132 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13133 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13134 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13135 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13136 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13137 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13138 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13139 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13140
13141Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13142192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13143
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013144IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13145Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13146trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13147IPv6 patterns.
13148
13149HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13150following situations :
13151 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13152 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13153 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13154 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13155 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13156 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13157 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13158 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13159 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13160 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162
131637.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13164----------------------------------
13165
13166Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13167combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13168
13169 - AND (implicit)
13170 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13171 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13178indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13181"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13182requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13183is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13184
13185 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013186 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13187 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13188 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189
13190To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13191and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13192
13193 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13194 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13195 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13196 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013198 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13200 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13201 use_backend www if host_www
13202
13203It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13204expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13205be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13206the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13207
13208 The following rule :
13209
13210 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013211 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212
13213 Can also be written that way :
13214
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013215 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216
13217It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13218to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13219simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13220sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13221good use is the following :
13222
13223 With named ACLs :
13224
13225 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13226 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13227 monitor fail if site_dead
13228
13229 With anonymous ACLs :
13230
13231 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13232
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013233See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13234keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235
13236
132377.3. Fetching samples
13238---------------------
13239
13240Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13241against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13242sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13243ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13244of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13245available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13246
13247This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13248Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13249compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13250deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13251
13252The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13253matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13254method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13255indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13256
13257As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13258when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13259mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13260the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13261ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13262
13263Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13264multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13265when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013266incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13267are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13269all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13270
13271Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13272 - name
13273 - name(arg1)
13274 - name(arg1,arg2)
13275
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013276
132777.3.1. Converters
13278-----------------
13279
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013280Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13281of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13282is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13283was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013284has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013285unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13286
13287These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13288sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13289the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013290support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013291
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013292A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13293support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13294supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13295(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13296bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013299
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001330051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13301 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13302 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13303 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13304 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13305 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13306
13307 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013308 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13309 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013310 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13311 frontend http-in
13312 bind *:8081
13313 default_backend servers
13314 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13315 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13316
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013317add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013318 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013319 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013320 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13321 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013322 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013323 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13324 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013328 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013329
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013330aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13331 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13332 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13333 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13334 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13335 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13336 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13337
13338 Example:
13339 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13340 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13341
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013342and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013343 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013344 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013345 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13346 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013347 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013348 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13349 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13350 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13351 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013352 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013353 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013354
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013355b64dec
13356 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13357 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13358
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013359base64
13360 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013362 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13363
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013364bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013365 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013366 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013367 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013368 presence of a flag).
13369
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013370bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13371 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13372 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013373 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013374
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013375concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13376 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13377 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13378 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13379 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13380 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13381 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13382 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13383 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13384 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13385 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013386 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013387 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013388 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013389
13390 Example:
13391 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13392 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13393 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13394 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13395
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013396cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013397 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13398 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013399
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013400crc32([<avalanche>])
13401 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13402 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13403 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13404 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13405 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13406 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13407 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13408 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13409 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13410 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013411 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13412
13413crc32c([<avalanche>])
13414 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13415 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13416 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13417 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13418 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13419 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13420 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13421 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013422
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013423da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013424 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13425 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13426 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13427 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013428 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013429 configuration language.
13430
13431 Example:
13432 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013433 bind *:8881
13434 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013435 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013436
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013437debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13438 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13439 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13440 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13441 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13442 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13443 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13444 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13445 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13446 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13447 printable sample types.
13448
13449 Example:
13450 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013451
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013452div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013453 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13454 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013455 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013456 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13457 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013458 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013459 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13460 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13461 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13462 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013463 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013464 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013465
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013466djb2([<avalanche>])
13467 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13468 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13469 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13470 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13471 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13472 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13473 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013474 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13475 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013476
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013477even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013478 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013479 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13480
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013481field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13482 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13483 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13484 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13485 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13486 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13487 fields.
13488
13489 Example :
13490 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13491 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13492 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13493 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13494 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013495
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013496hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013500 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013501
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013502hex2i
13503 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013504 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013505
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013506http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013507 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13508 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013509 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13510 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13511 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13512 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13513 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13514 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13515 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13516 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013518in_table(<table>)
13519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13521 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013522 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013523 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13524
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013525ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13526 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013527 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013528 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13529 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13530 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13531 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13532 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013533
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013534json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013536 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013537 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013538 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13539 of errors:
13540 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13541 bytes, ...)
13542 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13543 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13544
13545 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13546 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13547 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13548 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13549 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13550 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013551 - "ascii" : never fails;
13552 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13553 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013554 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013555 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013556 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13557 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13558
13559 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013560 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013561
13562 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013563 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013564 capture request header user-agent len 150
13565 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013566
13567 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13568 GET / HTTP/1.0
13569 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13570
13571 Output log:
13572 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013574language(<value>[,<default>])
13575 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13576 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13577 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13578 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13579 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13580 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13581 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13582 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13583 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013584 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013585 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13586 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013587
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013588 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13591 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013593 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13594 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13595 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13596 use_backend spanish if es
13597 use_backend french if fr
13598 use_backend english if en
13599 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013600
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013601length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013602 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13603 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13604 type. The result is of type integer.
13605
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013606lower
13607 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13609 type. The result is of type string.
13610
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013611ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13612 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13613 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13614 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13615 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13616 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13617 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13618
13619 Example :
13620
13621 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013622 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013623 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013625map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13626map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13627map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13628 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13629 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13630 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13631 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13632 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13633 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13634 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13635 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013636
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013637 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13638 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13639 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013640
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013641 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013642 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013644 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13645 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13646 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13647 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013648 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13649 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013650 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13651 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13652 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13653 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13654 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13655 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13656 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13657 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013658 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13659 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13660 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013661 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13662 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13663 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13664 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13665 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013666
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013667 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13668 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13669 the corresponding match text.
13670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013671 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13672 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13673 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13674 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13675 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013677 Example :
13678
13679 # this is a comment and is ignored
13680 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13681 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13682 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13683 | | | `---------- value
13684 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13685 | `---------------------------- key
13686 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013688mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013689 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13690 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013691 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013692 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13696 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13697 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013698 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013699 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013700
13701mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013702 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013703 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13704 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013705 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013706 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013707 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013708 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13709 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13710 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13711 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013713 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013714
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013715nbsrv
13716 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13717 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13718 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13719 map lookup.
13720
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013721neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013722 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13723 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13724 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13725 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013726
13727not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013728 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013729 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013730 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731 absence of a flag).
13732
13733odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013734 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013735 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13736
13737or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013738 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013739 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013740 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13741 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013748 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013749
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013750protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13751 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13752 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13753 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13754 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13755 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13756 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13757 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13758 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13759 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13760 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13761 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13762
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013763regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013764 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13765 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13766 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13767 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13768 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13769 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13770 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13771 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13772 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13773 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013774 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13775 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13776 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13777 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013778
13779 Example :
13780
13781 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13782 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13783 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13784 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13785
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013786capture-req(<id>)
13787 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13788 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13789
13790 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013791 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13792 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013793
13794capture-res(<id>)
13795 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13796 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13797
13798 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013799 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13800 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013801
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013802sdbm([<avalanche>])
13803 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13804 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13805 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13806 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13807 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13808 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13809 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013810 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13811 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013812
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013813set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13815 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13816 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013817 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013818 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13819 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013820 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013821 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013823 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013824 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013825
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013826sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013827 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013828 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13829
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013830sha2([<bits>])
13831 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13832 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13833
13834 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13835 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13836
13837 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13838 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13839
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013840srv_queue
13841 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13842 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13843 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13844 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13845 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13846
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013847strcmp(<var>)
13848 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13849 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13850 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13851 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13852 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13853 shorter).
13854
13855 Example :
13856
13857 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13858 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13859 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13860
13861
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013862sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013863 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13864 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013865 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013866 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13867 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13870 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013871 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013872 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13873 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013875 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013876
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013877table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13880 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13881 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13882 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13883 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13884
13885
13886table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13890 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13891 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13892 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13893
13894table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013898 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13899 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13900
13901table_conn_cur(<table>)
13902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13905 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13906 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13907
13908table_conn_rate(<table>)
13909 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13910 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13911 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13912 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13913 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13914
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013915table_gpt0(<table>)
13916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13919 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13920 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13921
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013922table_gpc0(<table>)
13923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13926 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13927 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13928
13929table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13930 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13931 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13932 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13933 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13934 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13935 sample fetch keyword.
13936
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013937table_gpc1(<table>)
13938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13940 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13941 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13942 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13943
13944table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13948 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13949 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13950 sample fetch keyword.
13951
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013952table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013956 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13957 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13958
13959table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13962 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13963 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13964 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13965 keyword.
13966
13967table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013971 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13972 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13973
13974table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13977 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13978 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13979 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13980 keyword.
13981
13982table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013986 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13987 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13988 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13989 keyword.
13990
13991table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013995 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13996 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13997 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13998 keyword.
13999
14000table_server_id(<table>)
14001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14004 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14005 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14006 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14007
14008table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014012 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14013 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14014 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14015 keyword.
14016
14017table_sess_rate(<table>)
14018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14021 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14022 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14023 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14024 keyword.
14025
14026table_trackers(<table>)
14027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14030 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14031 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14032 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14033 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14034 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14035 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14036 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14037
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014038upper
14039 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14040 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14041 type. The result is of type string.
14042
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014043url_dec
14044 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14045 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14046
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014047ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014048 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014049 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14050 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14051 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014052 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14053 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14054 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14055 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014056 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014057 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14058 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014059
14060 Example:
14061 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14062 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14063
14064 message Point {
14065 int32 latitude = 1;
14066 int32 longitude = 2;
14067 }
14068
14069 message PPoint {
14070 Point point = 59;
14071 }
14072
14073 message Rectangle {
14074 // One corner of the rectangle.
14075 PPoint lo = 48;
14076 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14077 PPoint hi = 49;
14078 }
14079
14080 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14081 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14082 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14083
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014084 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14085 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014086 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014087 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14088
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014089 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014090
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014091 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014092
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014093 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014094 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14095 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14096
14097 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14098 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14099 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14100
14101 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14102 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14103 interpret the previous binary sample.
14104
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014105
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014106unset-var(<var name>)
14107 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14108 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14109 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14110 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14111 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14112 response),
14113 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14114 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14115 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14116 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14117
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014118utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14119 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14120 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14121 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14122 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14123 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14124 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14125
14126 Example :
14127
14128 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014129 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014130 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14131
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014132word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14133 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14134 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14135 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14136 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14137 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14138
14139 Example :
14140 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14141 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14142 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14143 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14144 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014145
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014146wt6([<avalanche>])
14147 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14148 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14149 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14150 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14151 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14152 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14153 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014154 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14155 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014156
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014157xor(<value>)
14158 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014159 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014160 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014161 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014162 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014163 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14164 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014165 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014166 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14167 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014168 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014169 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014170
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014171xxh32([<seed>])
14172 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14173 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14174 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14175 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14176 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14177 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14178 as cryptographically secure.
14179
14180xxh64([<seed>])
14181 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14182 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14183 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14184 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14185 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14186 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14187 as cryptographically secure.
14188
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014189
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141907.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191--------------------------------------------
14192
14193A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14194not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14195"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14196The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14197
14198always_false : boolean
14199 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14200 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14201
14202always_true : boolean
14203 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14204 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14205
14206avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014207 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14209 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14210 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14211 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14212 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14213 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14214 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14215 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14216 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14217 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14218 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14219 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14220 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014223 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14224 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14225 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14226 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014227 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14228
14229be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14230 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14231 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14232 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14233 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14234 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014235 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14236 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014237
14238 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14239 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14240 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14243 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14244 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14245 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014246 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14248 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014249
14250 Example :
14251 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14252 backend dynamic
14253 mode http
14254 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14255 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014257bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014258 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14259 of the string.
14260
14261bool(<bool>) : bool
14262 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14263 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14266 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014267 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14269 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014270
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014271 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014272 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014273 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14274
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014275 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14276 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014277
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014278 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014279 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014281 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014282 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014284 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014285
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014286 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14287 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014289 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014290
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014291cpu_calls : integer
14292 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14293 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14294 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14295 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14296 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14297 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14298
14299cpu_ns_avg : integer
14300 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14301 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14302 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14303 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14304 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14305 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14306 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14307 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14308 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14309 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14310 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14311
14312cpu_ns_tot : integer
14313 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14314 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14315 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14316 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14317 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14318 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14319 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14320 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14321 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14322 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14323 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14324 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14325 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14326
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014327date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014328 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014329
14330 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14331 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14332 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014333 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14334
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014335 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14336 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14337 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14338 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14339 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14340
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014341 Example :
14342
14343 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14344 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014345
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014346 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14347 # millisecond granularity
14348 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14349
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014350date_us : integer
14351 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14352 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14353 from the same timeval structure.
14354
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014355distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14356 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14357 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14358 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14359 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14360 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14361 list of supported tokens.
14362
14363distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14364 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14365 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14366 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14367 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14368 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14369 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14370 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14371 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14372 supported tokens.
14373
14374 Example :
14375 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14376 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14377 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14378 # send large files to the big farm
14379 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14380
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014381env(<name>) : string
14382 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14383 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14384 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14385 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14386 certain way.
14387
14388 Examples :
14389 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14390 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14391
14392 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14393 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14396 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014397 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14398 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014399 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14400 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014401 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14403 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014404
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014405fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14407 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14408 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14412 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14413 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14414 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14415 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14416 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14417 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14418 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014419
14420 Example :
14421 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14422 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14423 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14424 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14425 frontend mail
14426 bind :25
14427 mode tcp
14428 maxconn 100
14429 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14430 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14431 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14432 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014433
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014434hostname : string
14435 Returns the system hostname.
14436
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014437int(<integer>) : signed integer
14438 Returns a signed integer.
14439
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014440ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14441 Returns an ipv4.
14442
14443ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14444 Returns an ipv6.
14445
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014446lat_ns_avg : integer
14447 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14448 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14449 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14450 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14451 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14452 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14453 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14454 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14455 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14456 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14457 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14458 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14459 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14460 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14461
14462lat_ns_tot : integer
14463 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14464 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14465 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14466 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14467 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14468 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14469 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14470 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14471 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14472 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14473 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14474 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14475 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14476 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14477 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14478 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14479 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14480 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14481 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14482
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014483meth(<method>) : method
14484 Returns a method.
14485
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014486nbproc : integer
14487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14488 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14489 and debugging purposes.
14490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14493 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14494 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014495 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14496 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14497 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014498
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014499prio_class : integer
14500 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14501 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14502 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14503
14504prio_offset : integer
14505 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14506 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14507 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14508 set-priority-offset".
14509
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014510proc : integer
14511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14512 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14513 debugging purposes.
14514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014516 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14517 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14518 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014519 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14520 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14521 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14522 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14523 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14524
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014525rand([<range>]) : integer
14526 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14527 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14528 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14529 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14530 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14531
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014532uuid([<version>]) : string
14533 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14534 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14535 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14538 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14539 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14540 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14541 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14542 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014543 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14544 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14545
14546srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14548 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14549 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14550 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14551 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14552 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14553 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14554
14555 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14556 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557
14558srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14559 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14560 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14561 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014562 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14564 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14565 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14566
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014567srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14569 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14570 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14571 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14572 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14573 fetch methods.
14574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14576 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14577 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014578 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14580 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014581 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582 overloading servers).
14583
14584 Example :
14585 # Redirect to a separate back
14586 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14587 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14588 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14589
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014590stopping : boolean
14591 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14592 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14593 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14594
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014595str(<string>) : string
14596 Returns a string.
14597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14599 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14600 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14601
14602table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14603 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14604 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14605 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14606
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014607thread : integer
14608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14609 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14610 and debugging purposes.
14611
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014612var(<var-name>) : undefined
14613 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014614 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14615 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014619 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014620 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14621 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014622 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014623 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626----------------------------------
14627
14628The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14629closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14630methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14631sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14632TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014633the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14634counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014635"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14636used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14637can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14638Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14639table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14640tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14641currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014642
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014643bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014644 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14645 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14646 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648be_id : integer
14649 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14650 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14651
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014652be_name : string
14653 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14654 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656dst : ip
14657 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14658 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14659 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14660 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014661 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14662 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14663 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14664 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14665 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14666 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014667
14668dst_conn : integer
14669 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14670 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14671 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14672 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14673 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14674 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14675 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14676 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014677
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014678dst_is_local : boolean
14679 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14680 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14681 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14682 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014683 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014684 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14685 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14686 it only once per connection.
14687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688dst_port : integer
14689 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14690 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14691 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14692 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14693 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14694 an HTTP header.
14695
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014696fc_http_major : integer
14697 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14698 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14699 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14700
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014701fc_pp_authority : string
14702 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14703 if any.
14704
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014705fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14706 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14707 header.
14708
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014709fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14710 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14711 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14712 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14713 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14714 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14715 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14716
14717fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14718 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14719 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14720 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14721 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14722 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14723 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14724
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014725fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014726 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14727 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14728 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14729 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14730
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014731fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014732 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14733 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14734 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14735 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14736
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014737fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014738 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14739 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14740 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14741 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14742
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014743fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014744 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14745 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14746 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14747 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14748
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014749fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014750 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14751 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14752 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14753 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14754
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014755fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014756 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14757 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14758 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14759 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14760
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014761fe_defbe : string
14762 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14763 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765fe_id : integer
14766 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014767 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14769
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014770fe_name : string
14771 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14772 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14773 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014775sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014776sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14777sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14778sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014779 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14780 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14781 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14782
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014783sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014784sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14785sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14786sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014787 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14788 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14789 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14790
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014791sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014792sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14793sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14794sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014795 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14796 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014797 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14798 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14799 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014800
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014801 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014802 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14803 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014804 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14805 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14806 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014807 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14808 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14809
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014810sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14811sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14812sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14813sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14814 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14815 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14816 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14817 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14818 when a first ACL was verified.
14819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014820sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014821sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14822sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14823sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014824 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014825 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014827sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014828sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14829sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14830sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014831 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14832 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14833 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014835sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014836sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14837sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14838sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014839 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14840 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14841 See also src_conn_rate.
14842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014843sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014844sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14845sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14846sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014847 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014848 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014849
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014850sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14851sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14852sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14853sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14854 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14855 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14856
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014857sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14858sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14859sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14860sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14861 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14862 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14863
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014864sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014865sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14866sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14867sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014868 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14869 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14870 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014871 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14872 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14873 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014874
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014875sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14876sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14877sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14878sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14879 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14880 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14881 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14882 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14883 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14884 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14885
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014886sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014887sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14888sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14889sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014890 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014891 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14892 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014894sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014895sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14896sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14897sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014898 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14899 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14900 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14901 src_http_err_rate.
14902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014903sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014904sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14905sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14906sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014907 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014908 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14909 src_http_req_cnt.
14910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014911sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014912sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14914sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014915 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14916 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14917 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14918 src_http_req_rate.
14919
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014920sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014921sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14922sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14923sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014924 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014925 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14926 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14927 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14928 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014929
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014930 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014931 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14932 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014933 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14934
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014935sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14936sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14937sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14938sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14939 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14940 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14941 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14942 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14943 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14944
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014945sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014946sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14947sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14948sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014949 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14950 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14951 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014952
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014953sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014954sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14955sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14956sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014957 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14958 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14959 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014961sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014962sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14963sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14964sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014965 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014966 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14967 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14968 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014969 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014970 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014972sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014973sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14974sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14975sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014976 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14977 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14978 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14979 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14980 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014981 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014983sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014984sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14985sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14986sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014987 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14988 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14989 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014991sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014992sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14993sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14994sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014995 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14996 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014997 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014998 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14999 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15001 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15002 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004so_id : integer
15005 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15006 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15007 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015010 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15012 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15013 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015014 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15015 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15016 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015017 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15018 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15019 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15020 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15021 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15022 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15023 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015024
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015025 Example:
15026 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15027 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015029src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15030 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15031 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15032 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015033 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15036 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15037 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015038 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015039 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15042 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15043 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15044 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15045 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15046 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15047 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015048
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015049 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015050 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15051 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15052 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15053 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015054 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015055 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15056 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015058src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15060 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15061 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15062 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15063 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15064 was verified.
15065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015067 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015069 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015070 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015073 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15075 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015076 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15079 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15081 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015082 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015085 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015087 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015088 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015089
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015090src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15091 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15093 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15094 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15095
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015096src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15097 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15098 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15099 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15100 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015103 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015105 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15106 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015107 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15108 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15109 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015110
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015111src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15112 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15113 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15114 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15115 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15116 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15117 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15118 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015121 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015123 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015124 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15128 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15129 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15130 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15131 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015132 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015135 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15137 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015138 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15141 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15142 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15143 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015144 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015145 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15148 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15149 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15150 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015151 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15153 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015154
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015155 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015156 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015157 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015158 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015159
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015160src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15161 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15162 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15163 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15164 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15165 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15166 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15167
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015168src_is_local : boolean
15169 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15170 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15171 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15172 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015173 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015174 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15175 once per connection.
15176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015178 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15179 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15180 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15181 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15182 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015185 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15186 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15187 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15188 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15189 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191src_port : integer
15192 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15193 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15194 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15195 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015198 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015199 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15200 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15201 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015202 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15205 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15206 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15207 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15208 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015209 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15212 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15213 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15214 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15215 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15216 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15217 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15218 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15219 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015220
15221 Example :
15222 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15223 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15224 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15225 listen ssh
15226 bind :22
15227 mode tcp
15228 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015229 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015231 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233srv_id : integer
15234 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15235 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15236 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015237
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015238srv_name : string
15239 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15240 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15241 debugging.
15242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152437.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015244----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15247closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15248when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15249usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015250future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015251
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001525251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15253 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15254 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15255 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15256 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15257 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15258
15259 Example :
15260 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15261 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15262 # the request.
15263 frontend http-in
15264 bind *:8081
15265 default_backend servers
15266 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15267 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15268
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015269ssl_bc : boolean
15270 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15271 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15272 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15273
15274ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15275 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15277
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015278ssl_bc_alpn : string
15279 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15280 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015281 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015282 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15283 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15284 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15285 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15286 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15287 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15288
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015289ssl_bc_cipher : string
15290 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15291 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15292
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015293ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15294 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15295 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15296 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15297
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015298ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15299 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15300 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15301 session or a TLS ticket.
15302
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015303ssl_bc_npn : string
15304 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15305 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015306 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015307 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15308 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15309 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15310 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15311 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15312
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015313ssl_bc_protocol : string
15314 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15315 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15316
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015317ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015318 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015319 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15320 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015321
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015322ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15323 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15324 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15325 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15326
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015327ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15328 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15329 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15330 if session was reused or not.
15331
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015332ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15333 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15334 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15335 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15336 BoringSSL.
15337
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015338ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15339 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15340 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15343 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15344 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15345 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15346 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15347 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15350 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15351 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15352 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15353 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015354
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015355ssl_c_der : binary
15356 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15357 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15358 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360ssl_c_err : integer
15361 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15362 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15363 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15364 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15365 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015366
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015367ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15369 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15370 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15371 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15372 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15373 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15374 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15375 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015376 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15377 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15378 LDAP v3.
15379 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15380 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382ssl_c_key_alg : string
15383 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15384 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15385 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387ssl_c_notafter : string
15388 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15389 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15390 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015392ssl_c_notbefore : string
15393 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15394 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15395 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015396
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015397ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15399 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15400 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15401 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15402 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15403 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15404 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15405 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015406 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15407 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15408 LDAP v3.
15409 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15410 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412ssl_c_serial : binary
15413 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15414 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15415 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15418 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15419 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15420 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015421 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15422 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15423
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015424 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015425 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15428 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15429 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15430 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432ssl_c_used : boolean
15433 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15434 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436ssl_c_verify : integer
15437 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15438 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15439 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15440 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442ssl_c_version : integer
15443 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15444 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015445
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015446ssl_f_der : binary
15447 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15448 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15449 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15450
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015451ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15453 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15454 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15455 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015456 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15458 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15459 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015460 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15461 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15462 LDAP v3.
15463 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15464 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466ssl_f_key_alg : string
15467 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15468 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15469 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471ssl_f_notafter : string
15472 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15473 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15474 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476ssl_f_notbefore : string
15477 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15478 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15479 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015480
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015481ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15483 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15484 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15485 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15486 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15487 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15488 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15489 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015490 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15491 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15492 LDAP v3.
15493 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15494 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496ssl_f_serial : binary
15497 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15498 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15499 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015500
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015501ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15502 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15503 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15504 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15507 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15508 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15509 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511ssl_f_version : integer
15512 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15513 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15514
15515ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015516 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15517 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15518 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 Example :
15521 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15522 listen http-https
15523 bind :80
15524 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15525 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15526
15527ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15528 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15529 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15530
15531ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015532 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15534 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15535 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15536 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15537 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15538 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15539 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15540 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542ssl_fc_cipher : string
15543 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15544 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015545
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015546ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15547 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15548 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015549 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015550
15551ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15552 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15553 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015554 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015555
15556ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15557 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15558 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15559 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015561 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015562
15563ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15564 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15565 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015566 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015567
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015568ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15569 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15570 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15571 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015574 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15575 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015576 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15577 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15578 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15579 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015580
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015581ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15582 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15583 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15584 wait until the handshake happened.
15585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15587 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015588 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15589 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015590 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015591 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015592
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015593ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015594 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015595 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15596 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015599 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15601 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15602 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15603 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15604 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15605 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15606 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608ssl_fc_protocol : string
15609 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15610 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015611
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015612ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015613 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015614 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15615 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015616
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015617ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15618 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15619 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15620 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15623 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15624 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15625 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15626 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015627
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015628ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15629 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15630 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15631 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15632 BoringSSL.
15633
15634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635ssl_fc_sni : string
15636 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15637 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15638 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15639 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15640 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15641
15642 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15643 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15644 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015645 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015646 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15650 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15653 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15654 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015655
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015656
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156577.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15661sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15662only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15663For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15664be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15665can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15666sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15667for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15668content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15673 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15676 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015677 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015679
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015680req.hdrs : string
15681 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15682 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15683 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15684 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15685
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015686req.hdrs_bin : binary
15687 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15688 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15689 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15690 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15691 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15692 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15693
15694 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15695
15696 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15697 str: <int:length><bytes>
15698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699req.len : integer
15700req_len : integer (deprecated)
15701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15702 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15703 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15704 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15705 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15706 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15707 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15708 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15711 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015712 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15713 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15714 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15715 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 ACL alternatives :
15718 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15721 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15722 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15723 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15724 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 ACL alternatives :
15727 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731req.proto_http : boolean
15732req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15733 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15734 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15735 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15736 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15737 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15738 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15739 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 Example:
15742 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15743 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15744 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015745 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15748rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15749 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15750 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15751 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15752 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15753 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15754 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15755 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15758 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15759 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15760 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15761 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15762 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764 ACL derivatives :
15765 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 Example :
15768 listen tse-farm
15769 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15770 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15771 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15772 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15773 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15774 persist rdp-cookie
15775 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15776 # This is only useful makes sense if
15777 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15778 stick-table type string size 204800
15779 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15780 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15781 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15784 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15787rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15788 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15789 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15790 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15791 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793 ACL derivatives :
15794 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015795
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015796req.ssl_alpn : string
15797 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15798 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15799 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15800 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15801 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15802 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015803 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015804
15805 Examples :
15806 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15807 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15808 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015809 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015810 default_backend bk_default
15811
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015812req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15813 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15814 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015815 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15816 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15817 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15818 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15819 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15822req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15823 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15824 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15825 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15826 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15827 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15828 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15829 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831req.ssl_sni : string
15832req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15833 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15834 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15835 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15836 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15837 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15838 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15839 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15840 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15841 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15842 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15843 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15844 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 ACL derivatives :
15847 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849 Examples :
15850 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15851 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15852 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15853 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15854 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015855
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015856req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15857 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15858 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15859 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15860 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15861 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15862 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15863 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15864 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15865 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867req.ssl_ver : integer
15868req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15869 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15870 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15871 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15872 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15873 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15874 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15875 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015876 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879 ACL derivatives :
15880 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015881
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015882res.len : integer
15883 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15884 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15885 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15886 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15887 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15888 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15889 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15890 content inspection.
15891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15893 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015894 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15895 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15896 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15897 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15900 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15901 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15902 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15903 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015906
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015907res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15908rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15909 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15910 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15911 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15912 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15913 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15914 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15915 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917wait_end : boolean
15918 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15919 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15922 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015923 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15925 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927 Examples :
15928 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15929 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15930 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15933 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15934 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15935 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15936 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15937 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15938 tcp-request content reject
15939
15940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159417.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942--------------------------------------
15943
15944It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15945This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15946data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15947its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15948HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15949content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15950to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15951more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15952response are indexed.
15953
15954base : string
15955 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15956 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15957 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15958 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15959 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15960 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15961 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15962 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15963
15964 ACL derivatives :
15965 base : exact string match
15966 base_beg : prefix match
15967 base_dir : subdir match
15968 base_dom : domain match
15969 base_end : suffix match
15970 base_len : length match
15971 base_reg : regex match
15972 base_sub : substring match
15973
15974base32 : integer
15975 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15976 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15977 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015978 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15979 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15980 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981
15982base32+src : binary
15983 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15984 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15985 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15986 per-URL counters.
15987
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015988capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15989 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15990 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15991 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15992
15993capture.req.method : string
15994 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15995 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15996 because it's allocated.
15997
15998capture.req.uri : string
15999 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16000 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16001 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16002 allocated.
16003
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016004capture.req.ver : string
16005 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16006 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16007 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16008
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016009capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16010 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16011 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16012 The first entry is an index of 0.
16013 See also: "capture response header"
16014
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016015capture.res.ver : string
16016 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16017 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16018 persistent flag.
16019
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016020req.body : binary
16021 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16022 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16023 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16024 the first chunk is analyzed.
16025
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016026req.body_param([<name>) : string
16027 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16028 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16029 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16030 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16031 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16032 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16033 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16034 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16035 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16036 given.
16037
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016038req.body_len : integer
16039 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16040 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16041 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16042 "option http-buffer-request".
16043
16044req.body_size : integer
16045 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16046 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16047 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16048 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16049 "option http-buffer-request".
16050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051req.cook([<name>]) : string
16052cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16053 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16054 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16055 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16056 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16057 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16058 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16059 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16060 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16061
16062 ACL derivatives :
16063 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16064 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16065 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16066 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16067 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16068 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16069 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16070 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16073cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16074 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16075 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16078cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16079 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16080 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16081 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16082 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16085 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16086 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16087 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16088 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016089 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16091 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16092 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16093 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16096 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16097 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16098 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16099 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016100 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16103 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16104 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16105 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16106 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16107 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16108 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16109 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16110 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16113 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16114 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16115 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16116 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16119 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16120 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16121 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16122 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16123 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16124 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16125 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16126 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016127 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016129 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131 ACL derivatives :
16132 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16133 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16134 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16135 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16136 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16137 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16138 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16139 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16140
16141req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16142hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16143 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16144 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16145 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16146 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16147 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16148 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16149 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16150 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16151 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16152
16153req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16154hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16155 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16156 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16157 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16158 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16159 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016160 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16162 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16163
16164req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16165hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16166 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16167 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16168 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16169 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16170 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16171 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16172 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16173
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016174
16175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16177 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16178 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16179 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16180 basic auth is supported.
16181
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016182http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16183 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16184 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16185 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16186 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16188 basic auth is supported.
16189
16190 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016191 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16192 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16193 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16194 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016196http_auth_pass : string
16197 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16198 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16199 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16200
16201http_auth_type : string
16202 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16203 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16204 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16205
16206http_auth_user : string
16207 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16208 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16209 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016212 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16213 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16215 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217method : integer + string
16218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16219 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16220 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16221 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16222 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16223 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16224 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226 ACL derivatives :
16227 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229 Example :
16230 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16231 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16232 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234path : string
16235 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16236 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16237 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16238 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16239 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016240 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243 ACL derivatives :
16244 path : exact string match
16245 path_beg : prefix match
16246 path_dir : subdir match
16247 path_dom : domain match
16248 path_end : suffix match
16249 path_len : length match
16250 path_reg : regex match
16251 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016252
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016253query : string
16254 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16255 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16256 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16257 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016258 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016259 which stops before the question mark.
16260
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016261req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16262 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16263 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16264 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16265 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267req.ver : string
16268req_ver : string (deprecated)
16269 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16270 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16271 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273 ACL derivatives :
16274 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276res.comp : boolean
16277 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16278 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16279 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281res.comp_algo : string
16282 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16283 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16284 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286res.cook([<name>]) : string
16287scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16288 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16289 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16290 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292 ACL derivatives :
16293 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16296scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16297 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16298 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16299 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16302scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16303 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16304 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16305 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16308 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16309 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16310 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16311 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16312 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16313 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16314 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16315 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16316 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16319 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16320 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16321 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16322 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16323 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16326shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16327 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16328 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16329 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16330 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16331 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16332 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16333 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16334 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336 ACL derivatives :
16337 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16338 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16339 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16340 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16341 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16342 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16343 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16344 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16345
16346res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16347shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16348 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16349 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16350 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16351 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16352 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16355shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16356 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16357 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16358 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16359 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16360 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16361 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016362
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016363res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16364 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16365 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16366 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16367 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16370shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16371 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16372 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16373 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16374 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16375 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16376 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016378res.ver : string
16379resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16380 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16381 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383 ACL derivatives :
16384 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16387 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16388 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016389 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16393 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395status : integer
16396 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16397 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16398 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016399
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016400unique-id : string
16401 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16402 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16403 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16404 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16405 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16406 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408url : string
16409 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16410 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16411 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16412 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16413 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16414 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16415 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417 ACL derivatives :
16418 url : exact string match
16419 url_beg : prefix match
16420 url_dir : subdir match
16421 url_dom : domain match
16422 url_end : suffix match
16423 url_len : length match
16424 url_reg : regex match
16425 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427url_ip : ip
16428 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16429 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16430 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16431 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16432 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16433 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16434 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436url_port : integer
16437 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16438 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16439 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16440 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016441
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016442urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16443url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16445 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016446 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16447 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16448 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16449 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16451 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016452 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16453 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455 ACL derivatives :
16456 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16457 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16458 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16459 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16460 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16461 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16462 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16463 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016464
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466 Example :
16467 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16468 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16469 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16470 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016471
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016472urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16474 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16475 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016476
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016477url32 : integer
16478 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16479 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16480 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16481 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16482 is an unsigned integer.
16483
16484url32+src : binary
16485 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16486 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16487 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16488
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016489
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100164907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16491---------------------------------------
16492
16493This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16494used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16495purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16496There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16497or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16498any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16499for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16500
16501internal.htx.data : integer
16502 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16503 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16504
16505internal.htx.free : integer
16506 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16507 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16508
16509internal.htx.free_data : integer
16510 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16511 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16512
16513internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16514 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16515 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16516 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16517
16518internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16519 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16520 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16521
16522internal.htx.size : integer
16523 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16524 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16525
16526internal.htx.used : integer
16527 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16528 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16529 direction.
16530
16531internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16532 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16533 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16534 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16535 of the special value :
16536 * head : The oldest inserted block
16537 * tail : The newest inserted block
16538 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16539
16540internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16541 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16542 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16543 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16544 integer or one of the special value :
16545 * head : The oldest inserted block
16546 * tail : The newest inserted block
16547 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16548
16549internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16550 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16551 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16552 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16553 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16554
16555 * head : The oldest inserted block
16556 * tail : The newest inserted block
16557 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16558
16559internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16560 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16561 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16562 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16563 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16564
16565 * head : The oldest inserted block
16566 * tail : The newest inserted block
16567 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16568
16569internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16570 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16571 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16572 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16573 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16574
16575 * head : The oldest inserted block
16576 * tail : The newest inserted block
16577 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16578
16579internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16580 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16581 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16582 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16583 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16584
16585 * head : The oldest inserted block
16586 * tail : The newest inserted block
16587 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16588
16589internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16590 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16591 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16592 it returns false.
16593
16594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016596---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016598Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16599every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016600order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016602ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16603---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016604FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016605HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016606HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16607HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016608HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16609HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16610HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16611HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16612LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016613METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016614METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016615METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16616METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16617METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16618METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016619METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016620METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016621RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016622REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016623TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016624WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16625---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166288. Logging
16629----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016631One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16632provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16633very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16634provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16635state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016636to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016637headers.
16638
16639In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16640about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16641send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16642
16643 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16644 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16645 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16646 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16647 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016648 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016649 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016650
16651The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16652allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16653as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16654while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16655real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16656delay.
16657
16658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166598.1. Log levels
16660---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016661
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016662TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016664HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16665in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16666track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16667syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16668about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669
16670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166718.2. Log formats
16672----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016673
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016674HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016675and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16676slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16677options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016678
16679 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16680 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16681 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16682 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16683 extents.
16684
16685 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16686 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16687 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16688 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16689 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16690
16691 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16692 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16693 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16694 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16695 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16696
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016697 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16698 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16699 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16700 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16701
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016702 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16703
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16705specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16706field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16707servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16708always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16709identifier.
16710
16711Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16712 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16713 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16714 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16715 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16716
16717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167188.2.1. Default log format
16719-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720
16721This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16722as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16723format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16724
16725 Example :
16726 listen www
16727 mode http
16728 log global
16729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16730
16731 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16732 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16733 (www/HTTP)
16734
16735 Field Format Extract from the example above
16736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16737 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16738 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16739 4 'to' to
16740 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16741 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16742
16743Detailed fields description :
16744 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16745 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16746 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16747 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16748 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16749 and processed the connection.
16750 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16751
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016752In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16753"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16754connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016756It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16757will eventually disappear.
16758
16759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167608.2.2. TCP log format
16761---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762
16763The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16764is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16765information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16766counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16767emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16768environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16769the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16770sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016771specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16772not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16773fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16774marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016775
16776 Example :
16777 frontend fnt
16778 mode tcp
16779 option tcplog
16780 log global
16781 default_backend bck
16782
16783 backend bck
16784 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16785
16786 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16787 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16788 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16789
16790 Field Format Extract from the example above
16791 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16792 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16793 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16794 4 frontend_name fnt
16795 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16796 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16797 7 bytes_read* 212
16798 8 termination_state --
16799 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16800 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16801
16802Detailed fields description :
16803 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016804 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16805 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16806 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016807 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016808 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016809 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016810
16811 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016812 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16813 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16814 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016815
16816 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16817 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16818 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016819 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16820 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16821 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16822 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016823
16824 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16825 and processed the connection.
16826
16827 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16828 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16829 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16830 applications.
16831
16832 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16833 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16834 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16835 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16836 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16837
16838 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16839 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16840 See "Timers" below for more details.
16841
16842 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16843 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16844 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16845 "Timers" below for more details.
16846
16847 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016848 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016849 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16850 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16851 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16852 details.
16853
16854 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16855 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16856 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16857 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16858 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16859
16860 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16861 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16862 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16863 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16864 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16865 for more details.
16866
16867 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016868 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016869 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16870 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16871 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016872 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016873
16874 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16875 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16876 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16877 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16878 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16879 caused by a denial of service attack.
16880
16881 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16882 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16883 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16884 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16885 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16886 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16887 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16888 denial of service attack.
16889
16890 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16891 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16892 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16893 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16894 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16895 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16896 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16897 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16898 be processed than on other servers.
16899
16900 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16901 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16902 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16903 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16904 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16905 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16906 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16907 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16908 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16909 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16910 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16911 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16912 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16913
16914 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16915 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16916 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16917 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16918 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16919 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016920 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16922
16923 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16924 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16925 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16926 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16927 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16928 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016929 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16931 occurs.
16932
16933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169348.2.3. HTTP log format
16935----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016936
16937The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16938is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16939the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16940are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16941emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16942generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16943"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16944which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016945frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16946is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016947
16948Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16949slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16950with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16951
16952 Example :
16953 frontend http-in
16954 mode http
16955 option httplog
16956 log global
16957 default_backend bck
16958
16959 backend static
16960 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16961
16962 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16963 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16964 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016965 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016966
16967 Field Format Extract from the example above
16968 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16969 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016970 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971 4 frontend_name http-in
16972 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016973 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016974 7 status_code 200
16975 8 bytes_read* 2750
16976 9 captured_request_cookie -
16977 10 captured_response_cookie -
16978 11 termination_state ----
16979 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16980 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16981 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16982 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16983 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016985Detailed fields description :
16986 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016987 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16988 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16989 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016990 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016991 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016992 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016993
16994 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016995 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16996 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16997 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016999 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17000 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017001
17002 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17003 and processed the connection.
17004
17005 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17006 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17007 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17008
17009 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17010 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17011 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17012 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17013 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17014 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17015
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017016 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17017 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17018 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017019 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017020 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17021 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017022 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17023 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017024
17025 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17026 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017027 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17030 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017031 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17032 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033
17034 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17035 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17036 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17037 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17038 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017039 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17040 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017042 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17043 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17044 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17045 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17046 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17047 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17048 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017049 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050
17051 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17052 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17053 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17054
17055 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17056 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017057 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17059 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17060 overflowing.
17061
17062 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17063 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17064 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17065 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17066 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17067 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17068 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17069 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17070
17071 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17072 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17073 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17074 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17075 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17076 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17077 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17078 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17079
17080 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17081 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17082 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17083 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17084 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17085 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17086 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17087
17088 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017089 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17091 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17092 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017093 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017094 system.
17095
17096 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17097 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17098 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17099 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17100 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17101 caused by a denial of service attack.
17102
17103 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17104 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17105 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17106 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17107 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17108 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17109 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17110 denial of service attack.
17111
17112 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17113 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17114 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17115 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17116 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17117 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17118 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17119 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17120 processed than on other servers.
17121
17122 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17123 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17124 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17125 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17126 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17127 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17128 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17129 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17130 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17131 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17132 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17133 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17134 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17135
17136 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17137 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17138 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17139 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17140 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17141 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017143 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17144
17145 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17146 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17147 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17148 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17149 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17150 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017151 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17153 occurs.
17154
17155 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17156 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17157 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17158 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17159 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17160 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17161 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17162 cookies" below for more details.
17163
17164 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17165 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17166 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17167 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17168 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17169 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17170 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17171 and cookies" below for more details.
17172
17173 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17174 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17175 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17176 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17177 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17178 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17179 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17180 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17181
17182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171838.2.4. Custom log format
17184------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017185
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017186The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017187mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017188
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017189HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017190Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17191separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17192prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17193
17194Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17195variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017196("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017197
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017198If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017199as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017200less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17201the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17202
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017203Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017204In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017205in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017206
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017207Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17208'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17209https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17210such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17211
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017212Flags are :
17213 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017214 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017215 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17216 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017217
17218 Example:
17219
17220 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17221 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17222
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017223 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17224
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017225At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17226
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017227 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17228 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017229
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017230the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017231
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017232 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17233 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17234 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017235
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017236and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17237
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017238 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17239 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017240
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017241Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17242
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017243 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017244 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017245 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17246 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17247 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017248 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17249 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17250 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017251 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017252 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17253 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017254 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017255 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17256 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017257 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017258 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017259 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017260 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017261 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017262 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017263 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017264 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17265 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17266 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17267 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17268 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017269 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017270 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17271 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017272 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017273 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17274 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017275 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17276 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17277 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017278 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017279 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17280 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017281 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017282 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17283 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17284 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017285 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017286 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017287 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17288 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17289 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17290 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017291 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017292 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017293 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017294 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017295 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017296 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017297 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17298 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17299 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017300 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017301 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17302 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017303 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017304 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17305 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017306 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017307 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017308 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017309 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017310
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017311 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017312
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017313
173148.2.5. Error log format
17315-----------------------
17316
17317When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17318protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17319By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17320"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017321will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017322logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17323
17324The format looks like this :
17325
17326 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17327 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17328 Connection error during SSL handshake
17329
17330 Field Format Extract from the example above
17331 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17332 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17333 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17334 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17335 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17336
17337These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17338failures.
17339
17340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173418.3. Advanced logging options
17342-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017343
17344Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17345just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17346options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17347for more information about their usage.
17348
17349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17351------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352
17353It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17354haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17355commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17356monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17357ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17358
17359 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17360 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17361 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17362 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17363
17364 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17365 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17366 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017367 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017368 such as other load-balancers.
17369
17370 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17371 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17372 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17373
17374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17376----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17379what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17380or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017381"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017382just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17383log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17384after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17385is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17386with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17387with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17388
17389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17391------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017392
17393Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17394for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17395"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17396retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17397raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17398a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17399file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17400you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17401"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17402
17403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17405--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017406
17407Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17408multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17409them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17410"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17411logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17412error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17413and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17414too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17415useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17416alternative.
17417
17418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174198.4. Timing events
17420------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017421
17422Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17423reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17424the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17425frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017426mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17427addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17428
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017429Timings events in HTTP mode:
17430
17431 first request 2nd request
17432 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17433 t tr t tr ...
17434 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17435 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17436 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17437 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17438 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17439
17440Timings events in TCP mode:
17441
17442 TCP session
17443 |<----------------->|
17444 t t
17445 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17446 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17447 |<------ Tt ------->|
17448
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017449 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017450 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017451 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17452 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17453 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017454 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017455 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17456 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17457 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17458 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017459
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017460 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17461 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17462 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017463 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17464 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17465 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17466 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17467 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17468 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017469
17470 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17471 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17472 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17473 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17474 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17475 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17476 request typed by hand during a test.
17477
17478 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17479 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017480 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017481 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17482 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17483 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17484 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485
17486 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17487 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17488 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17489 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17490 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17491
17492 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17493 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17494 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17495 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17496 connection never established.
17497
17498 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17499 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17500 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17501 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17502 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17503 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17504 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17505 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17506 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17507 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17508 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017510 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17511 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17512 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17513 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17514 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17515 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17516
17517 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17518
17519 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17520 "Ta" can never be negative.
17521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17523 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017524 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17525 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017526 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017528 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017529
17530 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017531 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17532 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017533
17534These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17535protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17536that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017537due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17538"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17539that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540
17541Most common cases :
17542
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017543 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17544 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17545 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17546 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17547 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17548 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17549 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17550 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17551 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17552 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17553 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017554 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017555
17556 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17557 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17558 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17559 of ms on remote networks.
17560
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017561 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17562 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17563 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017565 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17566 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17567 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17568 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17569 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17570 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17571 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17572 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17573 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017574
17575Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17576
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017577 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017578 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017579 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017580
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017581 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017582 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17583 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17584
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017585 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17587 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17588 flags.
17589
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017590 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17591 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017592 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17593 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17594 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17595 the client connection was maintained open.
17596
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017597 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017598 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017599 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017600 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17601
17602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176038.5. Session state at disconnection
17604-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605
17606TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17607"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176082-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17609each of which has a special meaning :
17610
17611 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17612 session to terminate :
17613
17614 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17615
17616 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17617 server explicitly refused it.
17618
17619 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17620 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17621 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17622 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017623 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017624
17625 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17626 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017627
17628 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17629 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17630 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17631 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17632 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17633
17634 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17635 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17636 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17637 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17638 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17639
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017640 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17641 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17642
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017643 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17644 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17645 backup connections when going up.
17646
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017647 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17648
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017649 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17650 send or receive data.
17651
17652 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17653 send or receive data.
17654
17655 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17656 with nothing left in the buffers.
17657
17658 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17659
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017660 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017661 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17662
17663 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17664 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17665 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17666 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17667 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17668
17669 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17670 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17671
17672 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17673 server (HTTP only).
17674
17675 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17676
17677 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17678 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17679 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17680
17681 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17682 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17683 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17684
17685 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17686
17687 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17688 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17689
17690 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17691 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17692 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17693
17694 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17695 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017696 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17697 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017698
17699 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17700 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17701 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17702 another server.
17703
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017704 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705 server.
17706
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017707 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17708 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17709 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17710 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17711
17712 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17713 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17714 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17715 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17716
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017717 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17718 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17719 "use-server" rule).
17720
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017721 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17722
17723 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17724 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17725
17726 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17727
17728 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17729 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17730 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17731
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017732 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17733 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017734 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017735 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17736 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17737
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017738 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17739
17740 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17741 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17742
17743 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17744
17745 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17746
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017747The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17748was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017749helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17750starvation, attacks, etc...
17751
17752The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17753alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17754easier finding and understanding.
17755
17756 Flags Reason
17757
17758 -- Normal termination.
17759
17760 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17761 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17762 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17763 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17764
17765 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17766 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17767 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17768 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17769 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17770 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017771
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017772 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17773 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017774 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017775
17776 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17777 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17778 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17779
17780 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17781 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17782 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17783 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17784 the server takes too long to respond.
17785
17786 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17787 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17788 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17789 long a time to respond.
17790
17791 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17792 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17793 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17794 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017795 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17796 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797
17798 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17799 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17800 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17801 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17802 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017803 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017804 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17805 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17806 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17807 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17808 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17809 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17810 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17811 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017812 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017813 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17814 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17815 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017816
17817 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17818 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017819 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17820 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17821 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17822 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017823
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017824 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17825 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017827 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17829 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017830 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017831 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17832 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17833
17834 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17835 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17836 503 or 504 here.
17837
17838 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17839 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17840 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17841 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17842 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17843
17844 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17845 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017846 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017847 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17848 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17849
17850 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17851 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17852 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17853 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17854 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17855 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17856 between haproxy and the server.
17857
17858 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17859 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17860 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17861 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17862 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17863 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17864 solution is to fix the application.
17865
17866 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17867 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17868 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17869 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17870 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17871 external attacks.
17872
17873 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17874 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017875 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17877 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17878
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017879 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17880 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17881 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017882 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017883 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017884
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17886 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17887 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17888 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017889 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17890 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17891 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17892 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17893 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017894
17895 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17896 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17897 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17898 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17899
17900 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17901 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17902 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17903 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17904
17905 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17906 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17907 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17908 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017910The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17911persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17912important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17913re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17914
17915 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17916
17917 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17918 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17919 set on a GET request.
17920
17921 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17922 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017923 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017924 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17925
17926 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17927 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17928 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17929
17930 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17931 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17932 already got a cookie.
17933
17934 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17935 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17936 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17937 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17938 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17939
17940 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17941 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17942 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17943
17944 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17945 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17946 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17947
17948 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17949 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17950
17951 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17952 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17953 then advertised in the response.
17954
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179568.6. Non-printable characters
17957-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958
17959In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17960consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17961converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17962prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17963being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17964escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17965is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17966'}' when logging headers.
17967
17968Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17969issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17970containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17971
17972Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17973the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17974performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17975
17976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179778.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17978---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979
17980Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17981achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017982section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017983cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17984the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17985the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017986locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17988user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17989a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17990wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17991
17992 Examples :
17993 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17994 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17995
17996 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17997 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17998
17999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180008.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18001---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018002
18003Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18004proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18005the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18006server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18007
18008Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18009response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018010section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018011
18012It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018013time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18014appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018015are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18016and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18017follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18018request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18019in the logs.
18020
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018021As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18022frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18023an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025 Example :
18026 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18027 listen proxy-out
18028 mode http
18029 option httplog
18030 option logasap
18031 log global
18032 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18033
18034 # log the name of the virtual server
18035 capture request header Host len 20
18036
18037 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18038 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18039
18040 # log the beginning of the referrer
18041 capture request header Referer len 20
18042
18043 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18044 capture response header Server len 20
18045
18046 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18047 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018049 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018050 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18051
18052 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18053 capture response header Via len 20
18054
18055 # log the URL location during a redirection
18056 capture response header Location len 20
18057
18058 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18059 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18060 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18061 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18062 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18063
18064 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18065 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18066 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18067 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018068 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069
18070 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18071 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18072 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18073 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18074 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018075 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018076
18077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180788.9. Examples of logs
18079---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018080
18081These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18082them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18083reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18084
18085 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18086 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18087 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18088
18089 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18090 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18091
18092 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18093 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18094 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18095
18096 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18097 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18098
18099 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18100 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18101 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18102
18103 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018104 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018105 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18106 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18107
18108 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18109 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18110 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18111
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018112 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18113 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18114 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18115 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18116 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18117 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118
18119 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018120 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018121
18122 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18123 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18124 Nothing was sent to any server.
18125
18126 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18127 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18128
18129 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18130 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018131 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018132 send a 408 return code to the client.
18133
18134 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18135 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18136
18137 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18138 5 seconds ("c----").
18139
18140 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18141 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018142 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018143
18144 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018145 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018146 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18147 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18148 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18149 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18150 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018151
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018152
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181539. Supported filters
18154--------------------
18155
18156Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18157accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18158unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18159
18160See also : "filter"
18161
181629.1. Trace
18163----------
18164
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018165filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018166
18167 Arguments:
18168 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18169 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18170
18171 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18172 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18173 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18174 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18175
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018176 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018177 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18178 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18179 amount of the parsed data.
18180
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018181 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018183This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18184callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18185information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18186filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18187
18188Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18189tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18190a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18191
18192
181939.2. HTTP compression
18194---------------------
18195
18196filter compression
18197
18198The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18199keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018200when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18201fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18202done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18203explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18204filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18205listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18206order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018207
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018208See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18209 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018210
18211
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182129.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18213--------------------------------------------
18214
18215filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18216
18217 Arguments :
18218
18219 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18220 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18221 parsed.
18222
18223 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18224 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18225 part must be placed in its own scope.
18226
18227The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18228external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018229streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018230exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18231also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18232
18233SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18234the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18235
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018236For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018237"doc/SPOE.txt".
18238
18239Important note:
18240 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18241 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18242
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182439.4. Cache
18244----------
18245
18246filter cache <name>
18247
18248 Arguments :
18249
18250 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18251
18252The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18253"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018254cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018255other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18256case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18257is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18258filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018259listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18260order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018261
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018262See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18263 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18264
18265
182669.5. Fcgi-app
18267-------------
18268
18269filter fcg-app <name>
18270
18271 Arguments :
18272
18273 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18274
18275The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18276request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18277reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18278used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18279implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18280used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18281fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18282used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18283order.
18284
18285See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18286 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18287
18288
1828910. FastCGI applications
18290-------------------------
18291
18292HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18293feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18294the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18295FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18296servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18297FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18298backend.
18299
18300HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18301application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18302connection.
18303
1830410.1. Setup
18305-----------
18306
1830710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18308--------------------------
18309
18310fcgi-app <name>
18311 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18312 document root must be defined.
18313
18314acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18315 Declare or complete an access list.
18316
18317 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18318 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18319 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18320 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18321 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18322
18323docroot <path>
18324 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18325 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18326 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18327
18328index <script-name>
18329 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18330 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18331 is an optional setting.
18332
18333 Example :
18334 index index.php
18335
18336log-stderr global
18337log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18338 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18339 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18340
18341 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18342 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18343
18344pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18345 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18346 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18347 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18348
18349 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18350 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18351 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18352 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18353
18354 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18355 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18356
18357path-info <regex>
18358 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18359 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18360 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18361 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18362 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18363
18364 Example :
18365 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18366
18367option get-values
18368no option get-values
18369 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18370
18371 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18372 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18373
18374 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18375 application will accept.
18376
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018377 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18378 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018379
18380 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18381 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18382 option is disabled.
18383
18384 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18385 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18386 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18387 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18388 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18389 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18390
18391option keep-conn
18392no option keep-conn
18393 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18394 sending a response.
18395
18396 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18397 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18398
18399option max-reqs <reqs>
18400 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18401 accept.
18402
18403 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18404 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18405 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18406 to 1.
18407
18408option mpxs-conns
18409no option mpxs-conns
18410 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18411
18412 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18413 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18414
18415set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18416 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18417 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18418 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18419 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18420
18421 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18422 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18423 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18424
18425 Example :
18426 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18427 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18428
18429 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18430
18431
1843210.1.2. Proxy section
18433---------------------
18434
18435use-fcgi-app <name>
18436 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18437
18438 Arguments :
18439 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18440
18441 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18442 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18443 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18444 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18445 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18446
18447 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18448 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18449 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18450 application are evaluated.
18451
18452
1845310.1.3. Example
18454---------------
18455
18456 frontend front-http
18457 mode http
18458 bind *:80
18459 bind *:
18460
18461 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18462 default_backend back-static
18463
18464 backend back-static
18465 mode http
18466 server www A.B.C.D:80
18467
18468 backend back-dynamic
18469 mode http
18470 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18471 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18472
18473 fcgi-app php-fpm
18474 log-stderr global
18475 option keep-conn
18476
18477 docroot /var/www/my-app
18478 index index.php
18479 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18480
18481
1848210.2. Default parameters
18483------------------------
18484
18485A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18486the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18487scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18488applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18489
18490 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18491 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18492 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18493 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18494 | | |
18495 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18496 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18497 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18498 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18499 | | application. |
18500 | | |
18501 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18502 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18503 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18504 | | |
18505 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18506 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18507 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18508 | | the application's configuration. |
18509 | | |
18510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18511 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18512 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18513 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18514 | | |
18515 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18516 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18517 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18518 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18519 | | be defined. |
18520 | | |
18521 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18522 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18523 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18524 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18525 | | is not set too. |
18526 | | |
18527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18528 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18529 | | set. |
18530 | | |
18531 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18532 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18533 | | the request. |
18534 | | |
18535 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18536 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18537 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18538 | | |
18539 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18540 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18541 | | script to process the request. |
18542 | | |
18543 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18544 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18545 | | |
18546 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18547 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18548 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18549 | | |
18550 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18551 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18552 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18553 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18554 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18555 | | |
18556 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18557 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18558 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18559 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18560 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18561 | | side. |
18562 | | |
18563 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18564 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18565 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18566 | | connected to. |
18567 | | |
18568 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18569 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18570 | | |
18571 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18572 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18573 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18574 | | |
18575 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18576
18577
1857810.3. Limitations
18579------------------
18580
18581The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18582way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18583during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18584establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18585application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18586or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18587message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18588these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18589and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18590
18591Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18592request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18593requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18594
18595About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18596into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18597fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18598"http-request" ones.
18599
18600Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18601FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18602processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18603must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18604here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018606/*
18607 * Local variables:
18608 * fill-column: 79
18609 * End:
18610 */